Download Technical Publication Direction 5308917
Transcript
GE Healthcare Technical Publication Direction 5308917-100 Revision 6 GE Healthcare LOGIQ P3 Service Manual Copyright© 2008-2011 by General Electric GE MEDICAL SYSTEMS DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 1-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ™ P3 SERVICE MANUAL - GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Important Precautions WARNING AVERTISSEMENT WARNUNG • THIS SERVICE MANUAL IS AVAILABLE IN ENGLISH ONLY. • IF A CUSTOMER’S SERVICE PROVIDER REQUIRES A LANGUAGE OTHER THAN ENGLISH, IT IS THE CUSTOMER’S RESPONSIBILITY TO PROVIDE TRANSLATION SERVICES. • DO NOT ATTEMPT TO SERVICE THE EQUIPMENT UNLESS THIS SERVICE MANUAL HAS BEEN CONSULTED AND IS UNDERSTOOD. • FAILURE TO HEED THIS WARNING MAY RESULT IN INJURY TO THE SERVICE PROVIDER, OPERATOR OR PATIENT FROM ELECTRIC SHOCK, MECHANICAL OR OTHER HAZARDS. • CE MANUEL DE MAINTENANCE N’EST DISPONIBLE QU’EN ANGLAIS. • SI LE PRESTATAIRE DE SERVICES DU CLIENT A BESOIN DE CE MANUEL DANS UNE AUTRE LANGUE QUE L’ANGLAIS, IL INCOMBE AU CLIENT DE LE FAIRE TRADUIRE. • NE PAS TENTER D’INTERVENTION SUR LES ÉQUIPEMENTS TANT QUE LE MANUEL DE MAINTENANCE N’A PAS ÉTÉ CONSULTÉ ET COMPRIS. • LE NON-RESPECT DE CET AVERTISSEMENT PEUT ENTRAÎNER CHEZ LE TECHNICIEN, L’OPÉRATEUR OU LE PATIENT DES BLESSURES DUES À DES DANGERS ÉLECTRIQUES, MÉCANIQUES OU AUTRES. • DIESES KUNDENDIENST-HANDBUCH EXISTIERT NUR IN ENGLISCHER SPRACHE. • FALLS EIN FREMDER KUNDENDIENST EINE ANDERE SPRACHE BENÖTIGT, IST ES AUFGABE DES KUNDEN, FÜR EINE ENTSPRECHENDE ÜBERSETZUNG ZU SORGEN. • WARTEN SIE DIESES GERÄT NUR, WENN SIE DIE ENTSPRECHENDEN ANWEISUNGEN IM KUNDENDIENST-HANDBUCH GELESEN HABEN UND NACHVOLLZIEHEN KÖNNEN. • WIRD DIESE WARNUNG NICHT BEACHTET, SO KANN ES ZU VERLETZUNGEN DES KUNDENDIENSTTECHNIKERS, DES BEDIENERS ODER DES PATIENTEN DURCH ELEKTRISCHE SCHLÄGE, MECHANISCHE ODER SONSTIGE GEFAHREN KOMMEN. i GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 AVISO ATENÇÃO AVVERTENZA HOIATUS ii LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL • ESTE MANUAL DE SERVICIO SÓLO ESTÁ DISPONIBLE EN INGLÉS. • SI ALGÚN PROVEEDOR DE SERVICIOS AJENO A GEMS SOLICITA UN IDIOMA QUE NO SEA EL INGLÉS, LA TRADUCCIÓN ES RESPONSABILIDAD DEL CLIENTE. • NO SE DEBERÁ DAR SERVICIO TÉCNICO AL EQUIPO SIN HABER CONSULTADO Y COMPRENDIDO ESTE MANUAL DE SERVICIO. • LA NO OBSERVANCIA DEL PRESENTE AVISO PUEDE DAR LUGAR A QUE EL PROVEEDOR DE SERVICIOS, EL USUARIO O EL PACIENTE SUFRAN LESIONES PROVOCADAS POR DESCARGAS ELÉCTRICAS, PROBLEMAS MECÁNICOS O PELIGROS DE OTRA NATURALEZA. • ESTE MANUAL DE ASSISTÊNCIA TÉCNICA SÓ SE ENCONTRA DISPONÍVEL EM INGLÊS. • SE QUALQUER OUTRO SERVIÇO DE ASSISTÊNCIA TÉCNICA, QUE NÃO A GEMS, SOLICITAR ESTES MANUAIS NOUTRO IDIOMA, É DA RESPONSABILIDADE DO CLIENTE FORNECER OS SERVIÇOS DE TRADUÇÃO. • NÃO TENTE REPARAR O EQUIPAMENTO SEM TER CONSULTADO E COMPREENDIDO ESTE MANUAL DE ASSISTÊNCIA TÉCNICA. • O NÃO CUMPRIMENTO DESTE AVISO PODE PÔR EM PERIGO A SEGURANÇA DO TÉCNICO, OPERADOR OU PACIENTE DEVIDO A CHOQUES ELÉTRICOS, MECÂNICOS OU OUTROS. • IL PRESENTE MANUALE DI MANUTENZIONE È DISPONIBILE SOLTANTO IN INGLESE. • SE UN ADDETTO ALLA MANUTENZIONE ESTERNO ALLA GEMS RICHIEDE IL MANUALE IN UNA LINGUA DIVERSA, IL CLIENTE È TENUTO A PROVVEDERE DIRETTAMENTE ALLA TRADUZIONE. • SI PROCEDA ALLA MANUTENZIONE DELL’APPARECCHIATURA SOLO DOPO AVER CONSULTATO IL PRESENTE MANUALE ED AVERNE COMPRESO IL CONTENUTO. • NON TENERE CONTO DELLA PRESENTE AVVERTENZA POTREBBE FAR COMPIERE OPERAZIONI DA CUI DERIVINO LESIONI ALL’ADDETTO ALLA MANUTENZIONE, ALL’UTILIZZATORE ED AL PAZIENTE PER FOLGORAZIONE ELETTRICA, PER URTI MECCANICI OD ALTRI RISCHI. • KÄESOLEV TEENINDUSJUHEND ON SAADAVAL AINULT INGLISE KEELES. • KUI KLIENDITEENINDUSE OSUTAJA NÕUAB JUHENDIT INGLISE KEELEST ERINEVAS KEELES, VASTUTAB KLIENT TÕLKETEENUSE OSUTAMISE EEST. • ÄRGE ÜRITAGE SEADMEID TEENINDADA ENNE EELNEVALT KÄESOLEVA TEENINDUSJUHENDIGA TUTVUMIST JA SELLEST ARU SAAMIST. • KÄESOLEVA HOIATUSE EIRAMINE VÕIB PÕHJUSTADA TEENUSEOSUTAJA, OPERAATORI VÕI PATSIENDI VIGASTAMIST ELEKTRILÖÖGI, MEHAANILISE VÕI MUU OHU TAGAJÄRJEL. - GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 VAROITUS ΠΡΟΕΙ∆ΟΠΟΙΗΣΗ FIGYELMEZTETÉS VIÐVÖRUN PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL • TÄMÄ HUOLTO-OHJE ON SAATAVILLA VAIN ENGLANNIKSI. • JOS ASIAKKAAN PALVELUNTARJOAJA VAATII MUUTA KUIN ENGLANNINKIELISTÄ MATERIAALIA, TARVITTAVAN KÄÄNNÖKSEN HANKKIMINEN ON ASIAKKAAN VASTUULLA. • ÄLÄ YRITÄ KORJATA LAITTEISTOA ENNEN KUIN OLET VARMASTI LUKENUT JA YMMÄRTÄNYT TÄMÄN HUOLTO-OHJEEN. • MIKÄLI TÄTÄ VAROITUSTA EI NOUDATETA, SEURAUKSENA VOI OLLA PALVELUNTARJOAJAN, LAITTEISTON KÄYTTÄJÄN TAI POTILAAN VAHINGOITTUMINEN SÄHKÖISKUN, MEKAANISEN VIAN TAI MUUN VAARATILANTEEN VUOKSI. • ΤΟ ΠΑΡΟΝ ΕΓΧΕΙΡΙ∆ΙΟ ΣΕΡΒΙΣ ∆ΙΑΤΙΘΕΤΑΙ ΣΤΑ ΑΓΓΛΙΚΑ ΜΟΝΟ. • ΕΑΝ ΤΟ ΑΤΟΜΟ ΠΑΡΟΧΗΣ ΣΕΡΒΙΣ ΕΝΟΣ ΠΕΛΑΤΗ ΑΠΑΙΤΕΙ ΤΟ ΠΑΡΟΝ ΕΓΧΕΙΡΙ∆ΙΟ ΣΕ ΓΛΩΣΣΑ ΕΚΤΟΣ ΤΩΝ ΑΓΓΛΙΚΩΝ, ΑΠΟΤΕΛΕΙ ΕΥΘΥΝΗ ΤΟΥ ΠΕΛΑΤΗ ΝΑ ΠΑΡΕΧΕΙ ΥΠΗΡΕΣΙΕΣ ΜΕΤΑΦΡΑΣΗΣ. • ΜΗΝ ΕΠΙΧΕΙΡΗΣΕΤΕ ΤΗΝ ΕΚΤΕΛΕΣΗ ΕΡΓΑΣΙΩΝ ΣΕΡΒΙΣ ΣΤΟΝ ΕΞΟΠΛΙΣΜΟ ΕΚΤΟΣ ΕΑΝ ΕΧΕΤΕ ΣΥΜΒΟΥΛΕΥΤΕΙ ΚΑΙ ΕΧΕΤΕ ΚΑΤΑΝΟΗΣΕΙ ΤΟ ΠΑΡΟΝ ΕΓΧΕΙΡΙ∆ΙΟ ΣΕΡΒΙΣ. • ΕΑΝ ∆Ε ΛΑΒΕΤΕ ΥΠΟΨΗ ΤΗΝ ΠΡΟΕΙ∆ΟΠΟΙΗΣΗ ΑΥΤΗ, ΕΝ∆ΕΧΕΤΑΙ ΝΑ ΠΡΟΚΛΗΘΕΙ ΤΡΑΥΜΑΤΙΣΜΟΣ ΣΤΟ ΑΤΟΜΟ ΠΑΡΟΧΗΣ ΣΕΡΒΙΣ, ΣΤΟ ΧΕΙΡΙΣΤΗ Ή ΣΤΟΝ ΑΣΘΕΝΗ ΑΠΟ ΗΛΕΚΤΡΟΠΛΗΞΙΑ, ΜΗΧΑΝΙΚΟΥΣ Ή ΑΛΛΟΥΣ ΚΙΝ∆ΥΝΟΥΣ. • EZEN KARBANTARTÁSI KÉZIKÖNYV KIZÁRÓLAG ANGOL NYELVEN ÉRHETŐ EL. • HA A VEVŐ SZOLGÁLTATÓJA ANGOLTÓL ELTÉRŐ NYELVRE TART IGÉNYT, AKKOR A VEVŐ FELELŐSSÉGE A FORDÍTÁS ELKÉSZÍTTETÉSE. • NE PRÓBÁLJA ELKEZDENI HASZNÁLNI A BERENDEZÉST, AMÍG A KARBANTARTÁSI KÉZIKÖNYVBEN LEÍRTAKAT NEM ÉRTELMEZTÉK. • EZEN FIGYELMEZTETÉS FIGYELMEN KÍVÜL HAGYÁSA A SZOLGÁLTATÓ, MŰKÖDTETŐ VAGY A BETEG ÁRAMÜTÉS, MECHANIKAI VAGY EGYÉB VESZÉLYHELYZET MIATTI SÉRÜLÉSÉT EREDMÉNYEZHETI. • ÞESSI ÞJÓNUSTUHANDBÓK ER EINGÖNGU FÁANLEG Á ENSKU. • EF ÞJÓNUSTUAÐILI VIÐSKIPTAMANNS ÞARFNAST ANNARS TUNGUMÁLS EN ENSKU, ER ÞAÐ Á ÁBYRGÐ VIÐSKIPTAMANNS AÐ ÚTVEGA ÞÝÐINGU. • REYNIÐ EKKI AÐ ÞJÓNUSTA TÆKIÐ NEMA EFTIR AÐ HAFA SKOÐAÐ OG SKILIÐ ÞESSA ÞJÓNUSTUHANDBÓK. • EF EKKI ER FARIÐ AÐ ÞESSARI VIÐVÖRUN GETUR ÞAÐ VALDIÐ MEIÐSLUM ÞJÓNUSTUVEITANDA, STJÓRNANDA EÐA SJÚKLINGS VEGNA RAFLOSTS, VÉLRÆNNAR EÐA ANNARRAR HÆTTU. iii GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 VÝSTRAHA ADVARSEL WAARSCHUWING BRĪDINĀJUMS iv LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL • TENTO SERVISNÍ NÁVOD EXISTUJE POUZE V ANGLICKÉM JAZYCE. • V PŘÍPADĚ, ŽE POSKYTOVATEL SLUŽEB ZÁKAZNÍKŮM POTŘEBUJE NÁVOD V JINÉM JAZYCE, JE ZAJIŠTĚNÍ PŘEKLADU DO ODPOVÍDAJÍCÍHO JAZYKA ÚKOLEM ZÁKAZNÍKA. • NEPROVÁDĚJTE ÚDRŽBU TOHOTO ZAŘÍZENÍ, ANIŽ BYSTE SI PŘEČETLI TENTO SERVISNÍ NÁVOD A POCHOPILI JEHO OBSAH. • V PŘÍPADĚ NEDODRŽOVÁNÍ TÉTO VÝSTRAHY MŮŽE DOJÍT ÚRAZU ELEKTRICKÁM PROUDEM PRACOVNÍKA POSKYTOVATELE SLUŽEB, OBSLUŽNÉHO PERSONÁLU NEBO PACIENTŮ VLIVEM ELEKTRICKÉHOP PROUDU, RESPEKTIVE VLIVEM K RIZIKU MECHANICKÉHO POŠKOZENÍ NEBO JINÉMU RIZIKU. • DENNE SERVICEMANUAL FINDES KUN PÅ ENGELSK. • HVIS EN KUNDES TEKNIKER HAR BRUG FOR ET ANDET SPROG END ENGELSK, ER DET KUNDENS ANSVAR AT SØRGE FOR OVERSÆTTELSE. • FORSØG IKKE AT SERVICERE UDSTYRET MEDMINDRE DENNE SERVICEMANUAL ER BLEVET LÆST OG FORSTÅET. • MANGLENDE OVERHOLDELSE AF DENNE ADVARSEL KAN MEDFØRE SKADE PÅ GRUND AF ELEKTRISK, MEKANISK ELLER ANDEN FARE FOR TEKNIKEREN, OPERATØREN ELLER PATIENTEN. • DEZE ONDERHOUDSHANDLEIDING IS ENKEL IN HET ENGELS VERKRIJGBAAR. • ALS HET ONDERHOUDSPERSONEEL EEN ANDERE TAAL VEREIST, DAN IS DE KLANT VERANTWOORDELIJK VOOR DE VERTALING ERVAN. • PROBEER DE APPARATUUR NIET TE ONDERHOUDEN VOORDAT DEZE ONDERHOUDSHANDLEIDING WERD GERAADPLEEGD EN BEGREPEN IS. • INDIEN DEZE WAARSCHUWING NIET WORDT OPGEVOLGD, ZOU HET ONDERHOUDSPERSONEEL, DE OPERATOR OF EEN PATIËNT GEWOND KUNNEN RAKEN ALS GEVOLG VAN EEN ELEKTRISCHE SCHOK, MECHANISCHE OF ANDERE GEVAREN. • ŠĪ APKALPES ROKASGRĀMATA IR PIEEJAMA TIKAI ANGĻU VALODĀ. • JA KLIENTA APKALPES SNIEDZĒJAM NEPIECIEŠAMA INFORMĀCIJA CITĀ VALODĀ, NEVIS ANGĻU, KLIENTA PIENĀKUMS IR NODROŠINĀT TULKOŠANU. • NEVEICIET APRĪKOJUMA APKALPI BEZ APKALPES ROKASGRĀMATAS IZLASĪŠANAS UN SAPRAŠANAS. • ŠĪ BRĪDINĀJUMA NEIEVĒROŠANA VAR RADĪT ELEKTRISKĀS STRĀVAS TRIECIENA, MEHĀNISKU VAI CITU RISKU IZRAISĪTU TRAUMU APKALPES SNIEDZĒJAM, OPERATORAM VAI PACIENTAM. - GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 ĮSPĖJIMAS ADVARSEL OSTRZEŻENIE ATENŢIE PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL • ŠIS EKSPLOATAVIMO VADOVAS YRA IŠLEISTAS TIK ANGLŲ KALBA. • JEI KLIENTO PASLAUGŲ TEIKĖJUI REIKIA VADOVO KITA KALBA – NE ANGLŲ, VERTIMU PASIRŪPINTI TURI KLIENTAS. • NEMĖGINKITE ATLIKTI ĮRANGOS TECHNINĖS PRIEŽIŪROS DARBŲ, NEBENT VADOVAUTUMĖTĖS ŠIUO EKSPLOATAVIMO VADOVU IR JĮ SUPRASTUMĖTE • NEPAISANT ŠIO PERSPĖJIMO, PASLAUGŲ TEIKĖJAS, OPERATORIUS AR PACIENTAS GALI BŪTI SUŽEISTAS DĖL ELEKTROS SMŪGIO, MECHANINIŲ AR KITŲ PAVOJŲ. • DENNE SERVICEHÅNDBOKEN FINNES BARE PÅ ENGELSK. • HVIS KUNDENS SERVICELEVERANDØR TRENGER ET ANNET SPRÅK, ER DET KUNDENS ANSVAR Å SØRGE FOR OVERSETTELSE. • IKKE FORSØK Å REPARERE UTSTYRET UTEN AT DENNE SERVICEHÅNDBOKEN ER LEST OG FORSTÅTT. • MANGLENDE HENSYN TIL DENNE ADVARSELEN KAN FØRE TIL AT SERVICELEVERANDØREN, OPERATØREN ELLER PASIENTEN SKADES PÅ GRUNN AV ELEKTRISK STØT, MEKANISKE ELLER ANDRE FARER. • NINIEJSZY PODRĘCZNIK SERWISOWY DOSTĘPNY JEST JEDYNIE W JĘZYKU ANGIELSKIM. • JEŚLI FIRMA ŚWIADCZĄCA KLIENTOWI USłUGI SERWISOWE WYMAGA UDOSTĘPNIENIA PODRĘCZNIKA W JĘZYKU INNYM NIŻ ANGIELSKI, OBOWIĄZEK ZAPEWNIENIA STOSOWNEGO TłUMACZENIA SPOCZYWA NA KLIENCIE. • NIE PRÓBOWAĆ SERWISOWAĆ NINIEJSZEGO SPRZĘTU BEZ UPRZEDNIEGO ZAPOZNANIA SIĘ Z PODRĘCZNIKIEM SERWISOWYM. • NIEZASTOSOWANIE SIĘ DO TEGO OSTRZEŻENIA MOżE GROZIĆ OBRAŻENIAMI CIAłA SERWISANTA, OPERATORA LUB PACJENTA W WYNIKU PORAŻENIA PRĄDEM, URAZU MECHANICZNEGO LUB INNEGO RODZAJU ZAGROŻEŃ. • ACEST MANUAL DE SERVICE ESTE DISPONIBIL NUMAI ÎN LIMBA ENGLEZĂ. • DACĂ UN FURNIZOR DE SERVICII PENTRU CLIENŢI NECESITĂ O ALTĂ LIMBĂ DECÂT CEA ENGLEZĂ, ESTE DE DATORIA CLIENTULUI SĂ FURNIZEZE O TRADUCERE. • NU ÎNCERCAŢI SĂ REPARAŢI ECHIPAMENTUL DECÂT ULTERIOR CONSULTĂRII ŞI ÎNŢELEGERII ACESTUI MANUAL DE SERVICE. • IGNORAREA ACESTUI AVERTISMENT AR PUTEA DUCE LA RĂNIREA DEPANATORULUI, OPERATORULUI SAU PACIENTULUI ÎN URMA PERICOLELOR DE ELECTROCUTARE, MECANICE SAU DE ALTĂ NATURĂ. v GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 ОСТОРОЖНО! UPOZORNENIE VARNING DİKKAT vi LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL • ДАННОЕ РУКОВОДСТВО ПО ОБСЛУЖИВАНИЮ ПРЕДОСТАВЛЯЕТСЯ ТОЛЬКО НА АНГЛИЙСКОМ ЯЗЫКЕ. • ЕСЛИ СЕРВИСНОМУ ПЕРСОНАЛУ КЛИЕНТА НЕОБХОДИМО РУКОВОДСТВО НЕ НА АНГЛИЙСКОМ ЯЗЫКЕ, КЛИЕНТУ СЛЕДУЕТ САМОСТОЯТЕЛЬНО ОБЕСПЕЧИТЬ ПЕРЕВОД. • ПЕРЕД ОБСЛУЖИВАНИЕМ ОБОРУДОВАНИЯ ОБЯЗАТЕЛЬНО ОБРАТИТЕСЬ К ДАННОМУ РУКОВОДСТВУ И ПОЙМИТЕ ИЗЛОЖЕННЫЕ В НЕМ СВЕДЕНИЯ. • НЕСОБЛЮДЕНИЕ УКАЗАННЫХ ТРЕБОВАНИЙ МОЖЕТ ПРИВЕСТИ К ТОМУ, ЧТО СПЕЦИАЛИСТ ПО ТЕХОБСЛУЖИВАНИЮ, ОПЕРАТОР ИЛИ ПАЦИЕНТ ПОЛУЧАТ УДАР ЗЛЕКТРИЧЕСКИМ ТОКОМ, МЕХАНИЧЕСКУЮ ТРАВМУ ИЛИ ДРУГОЕ ПОВРЕЖДЕНИЕ. • TÁTO SERVISNÁ PRÍRUČKA JE K DISPOZÍCII LEN V ANGLIČTINE. • AK ZÁKAZNÍKOV POSKYTOVATEĽ SLUŽIEB VYŽADUJE INÝ JAZYK AKO ANGLIČTINU, POSKYTNUTIE PREKLADATEĽSKÝCH SLUŽIEB JE ZODPOVEDNOSŤOU ZÁKAZNÍKA. • NEPOKÚŠAJTE SA VYKONÁVAŤ SERVIS ZARIADENIA SKÔR, AKO SI NEPREČÍTATE SERVISNÚ PRÍRUČKU A NEPOROZUMIETE JEJ. • ZANEDBANIE TOHTO UPOZORNENIA MÔŽE VYÚSTIŤ DO ZRANENIA POSKYTOVATEĽA SLUŽIEB, OBSLUHUJÚCEJ OSOBY ALEBO PACIENTA ELEKTRICKÝM PRÚDOM, PRÍPADNE DO MECHANICKÉHO ALEBO INÉHO NEBEZPEČENSTVA. • DEN HÄR SERVICEHANDBOKEN FINNS BARA TILLGÄNGLIG PÅ ENGELSKA. • OM EN KUNDS SERVICETEKNIKER HAR BEHOV AV ETT ANNAT SPRÅK ÄN ENGELSKA ANSVARAR KUNDEN FÖR ATT TILLHANDAHÅLLA ÖVERSÄTTNINGSTJÄNSTER. • FÖRSÖK INTE UTFÖRA SERVICE PÅ UTRUSTNINGEN OM DU INTE HAR LÄST OCH FÖRSTÅR DEN HÄR SERVICEHANDBOKEN. • OM DU INTE TAR HÄNSYN TILL DEN HÄR VARNINGEN KAN DET RESULTERA I SKADOR PÅ SERVICETEKNIKERN, OPERATÖREN ELLER PATIENTEN TILL FÖLJD AV ELEKTRISKA STÖTAR, MEKANISKA FAROR ELLER ANDRA FAROR. • BU SERVİS KILAVUZU YALNIZCA İNGİLİZCE OLARAK SAĞLANMIŞTIR. • EĞER MÜŞTERİ TEKNİSYENİ KILAVUZUN İNGİLİZCE DIŞINDAKİ BİR DİLDE OLMASINI İSTERSE, KILAVUZU TERCÜME ETTİRMEK MÜŞTERİNİN SORUMLULUĞUNDADIR. • SERVİS KILAVUZUNU OKUYUP ANLAMADAN EKİPMANLARA MÜDAHALE ETMEYİNİZ. • BU UYARININ GÖZ ARDI EDİLMESİ, ELEKTRİK ÇARPMASI YA DA MEKANİK VEYA DİĞER TÜRDEN KAZALAR SONUCUNDA TEKNİSYENİN, OPERATÖRÜN YA DA HASTANIN YARALANMASINA YOL AÇABİLİR. - GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL vii GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL DAMAGE IN TRANSPORTATION All packages should be closely examined at time of delivery. If damage is apparent write “Damage In Shipment” on ALL copies of the freight or express bill BEFORE delivery is accepted or “signed for” by a GE representative or hospital receiving agent. Whether noted or concealed, damage MUST be reported to the carrier immediately upon discovery, or in any event, within 14 days after receipt, and the contents and containers held for inspection by the carrier. A transportation company will not pay a claim for damage if an inspection is not requested within this 14 day period. CERTIFIED ELECTRICAL CONTRACTOR STATEMENT - FOR USA ONLY All electrical Installations that are preliminary to positioning of the equipment at the site prepared for the equipment shall be performed by licensed electrical contractors. Other connections between pieces of electrical equipment, calibrations and testing shall be performed by qualified GE Healthcare personnel. In performing all electrical work on these products, GE will use its own specially trained field engineers. All of GE’s electrical work on these products will comply with the requirements of the applicable electrical codes. The purchaser of GE equipment shall only utilize qualified personnel (i.e., GE’s field engineers, personnel of third-party service companies with equivalent training, or licensed electricians) to perform electrical servicing on the equipment. OMISSIONS & ERRORS If there are any omissions, errors or suggestions for improving this documentation, please contact the GE Healthcare Global Documentation Group with specific information listing the system type, manual title, part number, revision number, page number and suggestion details. Mail the information to: Service Documentation, 9900 Innovation Drive (RP-2123), Wauwatosa, WI 53226. GE Healthcare employees should use the iTrak System to report all documentation errors or omissions. viii - GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL LEGAL NOTES The contents of this publication may not be copied or duplicated in any form, in whole or in part, without prior written permission of GE Healthcare. GE Healthcare may revise this publication from time to time without written notice. TRADEMARKS All products and their name brands are trademarks of their respective holders. COPYRIGHTS All Material Copyright© 2008/2011 by General Electric Inc. All Rights Reserved. NOTE: THIS MANUAL IS APPLICABLE TO ALL TYPES OF LOGIQ P3 and LOGIQ P3 BT10. 1.) LOGIQ P3 2.) LOGIQ P3 PRO 3.) LOGIQ P3 EXPERT 4.) LOGIQ P3 VET ix GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Revision History Revision Date Reason for change 1 June 12, 2008 Initial Release 2 Sep 20, 2008 Updated safety information 3 Jan 09, 2009 UpdatedSafety Information 4 June 05,2009 Updated Software fru part num 5 Jan, 2011 Updated LOGIQ P3 BT10 content and images 6 April 2011 Content changes List of Effected Pages Pages Revision Title Page 6 Important Precautions pages i to x Table of Contents pages xi to xxviii Chapter 1 - Introduction pages 1-1 to 1-20 Chapter 2 - Pre-Installation pages 2-1 to 2-11 x 6 6 Pages Chapter 3 - Installation pages 3-1 to 3-31 Chapter 4 - Functional Checks pages 4-1 to 4-37 Chapter 5 - Components and Functions (Theory) Revision Pages Revision 6 Chapter 8 - Replacement Procedures 6 pages 8-1 to 8-93 6 6 pages 5-1 to 5-30 6 6 Chapter 6 - Service Adjustments pages 6-1 to 6-2 Chapter 7 - Diagnostics/ Troubleshooting pages 7-1 to 7-26 - 5 6 Chapter 9 - Replacement Parts pages 9-1 to 9-20 Chapter 10 - Periodic Maintenance pages 10-1 to 10-31 Index pages I to 4 Back Cover 6 6 6 6 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL CHAPTER 1 Introduction Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Purpose of Chapter 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Chapter Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Purpose of Proprietary Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Typical Users of the Basic Service Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LOGIQ P3 Models Covered by this Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LOGIQ P3 BT10 Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Purpose of Operator Manual(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1 1-1 1-1 1-1 1-2 1-2 1-3 1-3 Important Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Conventions Used in Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Standard Hazard Icons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Product Icons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4 1-4 1-5 1-6 Safety Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Human Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electrical Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Labels Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Warning labels location Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dangerous Procedure Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lockout/Tagout Requirements (For USA Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Returning/Shipping Probes and Repair Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 10 1 - 10 1 - 10 1 - 10 1 - 11 1 - 11 1 - 17 1 - 18 1 - 18 1 - 18 EMC, EMI, and ESD. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electromagnetic Compatibility (EMC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CE Compliance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Prevention . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 19 1 - 19 1 - 19 1 - 19 Customer Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 20 Contact Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 20 System Manufacturer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 21 Table of Contents 1 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL CHAPTER 2 Pre Installation Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 1 Purpose of this chapter 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 1 Chapter Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 1 General Console Requirements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 2 Console Environmental Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 2 Cooling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 2 Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 2 Electrical Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 3 LOGIQ P3 Power Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 3 Inrush Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 4 Site Circuit Breaker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 4 Site Power Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 4 Unit Power Plug . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 4 Power Stability Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 4 EMI Limitations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 5 Scan Probe Environmental Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 6 Time and Manpower Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 6 Facility Needs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 7 Recommended Ultrasound Room Layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 7 Purchaser Responsibilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 7 Required Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 8 Desirable Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 8 Recommended and Alternate Ultrasound Room Layout . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 9 Networking Pre-installation Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 10 Stand Alone Scanner (without Network Connection) . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 10 Scanner Connected to Hospital’s Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 10 Purpose of DICOM Network Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 10 DICOM Option Pre-installation Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 10 2 Table of Contents GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL CHAPTER 3 Installation Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Purpose of Chapter 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Average Installation Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Safety Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1 3-1 3-1 3-2 3-2 Receiving and Unpacking the Equipment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Moving into Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Adjusting System Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Product Locator Installation Card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3 3-7 3-7 3-8 Packing the Equipment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 8 Preparing for Installation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Verify Customer Order . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Physical Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . System Voltage Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . EMI Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Checking the Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9 3-9 3-9 3-9 3-9 3-9 Completing the Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power On / Boot Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Scanner Power On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Turn on the system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Off/ Shutdown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Back-end Processor Power Down - LOGIQ P3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Back-end Processor Power Down - LOGIQ P3 BT10 . . . . . . . . . . . Scanner Shutdown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Transducer Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 10 3 - 10 3 - 10 3 - 11 3 - 11 3 - 11 3 - 12 3 - 13 3 - 13 System Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . System Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Physical Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approved peripherals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Connecting Cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Peripherals/Accessories Connector Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rear Panel Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TOP Panel Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . This section indicates the pin assignment for each connector. . . . . Connect peripherals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Configuring the Bluetooth Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 15 3 - 15 3 - 15 3 - 15 3 - 16 3 - 16 3 - 16 3 - 17 3 - 18 3 - 19 3 - 25 Table of Contents 3 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Available Probes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 26 Software/Option Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 27 Connectivity Installation Worksheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 28 Loading Base Image Software. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 29 Software Version check out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 30 Functional Check-out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 30 Paperwork . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 31 Product Locator Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 31 User Manual(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 31 4 Table of Contents GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL CHAPTER 4 Functional Checks ................................................................ Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 1 Purpose for Chapter 4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 1 Required Equipment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 1 General Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power On/Boot Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Boot Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Turn on the system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Off/ Shutdown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TMST Power Down . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Scanner Shutdown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Full Maintenance Reboot (LOGIQ P3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Archiving and Loading Presets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Archiving Presets to a DVD-R Disk (or USB memory device) . . . . . Loading Presets from a DVD-R disk (or USB memory device) . . . . Adjusting the Display Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . System Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Control Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LOGIQ P3 SoftMenu Key Tour . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Monitor Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B Mode Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B Mode OP Panel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B Mode Softmenu Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . M Mode Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . M Mode OP Panel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . M Mode Softmenu Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Color Flow Mode Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Color Flow Mode OP Panel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Color Flow Mode Softemenu Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Doppler Mode Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Doppler Mode OP Panel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Doppler Mode OP Panel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Basic Measurements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Distance and Tissue Depth Measurements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Circumference/Area (Ellipse) Measurement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Worksheets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Probe/Connectors Usage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table of Contents 4-2 4-2 4-2 4-3 4-3 4-3 4-4 4-4 4-5 4-5 4-6 4-6 4-7 4-7 4-8 4-9 4 - 10 4 - 10 4 - 11 4 - 12 4 - 13 4 - 13 4 - 14 4 - 15 4 - 16 4 - 16 4 - 17 4 - 18 4 - 20 4 - 20 4 - 21 4 - 22 4 - 24 4 - 24 4 - 24 4 - 24 4 - 25 5 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Connecting a probe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 25 Activating the probe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 25 Deactivating the probe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 25 Disconnecting the probe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 25 Using Cine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 25 Activating CINE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 25 Quickly Move to Start/End Frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 25 Start Frame/End Frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 25 Adjusting the CINE Loop Playback Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 26 Moving through a CINE Loop Frame By Frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 26 Image Management (QG) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 26 Backup and Restore Database, Preset Configurations and Images . . . . . . 4 - 27 Formatting Media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 27 Backup System Presets and Configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 28 Restore System Presets and Configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 29 Archiving Images . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 30 Full Backup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 32 Patient Healthcare Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 36 Software Configuration Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 37 Peripheral Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 37 PC based products - Vulnerability and Precautions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 38 6 Table of Contents GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL CHAPTER 5 Components and Functions (Theory) Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Block Diagram - Logiq P3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Block Diagram - LOGIQ P3 BT10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Front End . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The Back End . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Top Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . External I/O . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Peripherals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Up sequence description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Down sequence description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PWA Assy Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TMST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RX64 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TX64 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CWD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Connector Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rear Panel-1 & Rear panel 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Keyboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Indicator LEDs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1 5-2 5-3 5-4 5-5 5-6 5-6 5-8 5-8 5-9 5 - 10 5 - 10 5 - 11 5 - 11 5 - 13 5 - 14 5 - 14 5 - 15 5 - 15 5 - 16 5 - 16 5 - 17 5 - 18 5 - 20 5 - 21 Power Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 22 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 22 Common Service Platform . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Global Service User Interface (GSUI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Internationalization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Service Login . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Access / Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . For a service call with no FRU replacement, use the following debrief Script: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RFS (Request for Service) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sending RFS Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table of Contents 5 - 24 5 - 24 5 - 24 5 - 24 5 - 24 5 - 24 5 - 25 5 - 26 5 - 26 5 - 26 7 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Machine RFS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 28 Enabling MRFS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 28 8 Table of Contents GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL CHAPTER 6 Service Adjustments Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 - 1 Purpose of this chapter 6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 - 1 Monitor Adjustments. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 - 2 Adjustments Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 - 2 Monitor Calibration procedure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 - 2 Table of Contents 9 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL CHAPTER 7 Diagnostics/Troubleshooting Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 1 Purpose of Chapter 7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 1 Gathering Trouble Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 2 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 2 Collect Vital System Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 2 Collect a Trouble Image with Logs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 3 USB Quick Save . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 4 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 4 Check and Record the P3 Key Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 4 Setting the P3 Key to USB Quick Save . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 5 Screen Captures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 6 Check and Record the P3 Key Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 6 Setting the P3 Key to Screen Capture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 6 Capturing a Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 6 Reset the P3 Key to Customer’s Functionality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 8 Wire - LAN Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 9 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 10 Console Troubleshooting Trees . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 10 System Doesn’t Boot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 10 B Mode Low Sensitivity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 12 B Mode Low Image Quality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 13 Noise in B Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 14 Color Flow Low Sensitivity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 15 Spectrum Doppler Low Sensitivity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 16 Noise in Color Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 17 Scan Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 18 Trackball . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 20 LCD Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 21 Peripheral Troubleshooting Trees . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 22 Unable Recording by Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 22 Drive Issue DVD-RW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 23 LCD Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 24 Network Troubleshooting Trees . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 24 No Connection to the Network at All . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 24 10 Table of Contents GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL CHAPTER 8 Replacement Procedures Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Purpose of Chapter 8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ................................................................ Disassembly/Re-assembly of LOGIQ P3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Warning and Caution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Returning/Shipping for repairs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Standard tools list for LOGIQ P3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LCD Assy (FRU P/N: 5315112-LP3, 5396925-LP3 BT10) . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mounting Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LCD Arm Cover (FRU P/N: 5310093) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Handle P3 Console (FRU P/N: 5315120) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Keyboard Assembly (FRU P/N: 5314404) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Replace Keyboard Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TGC PWA FRU Assy (FRU P/N: 5315107) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table of Contents 8-1 8-1 8-2 8-2 8-2 8-3 8-4 8-4 8-4 8-4 8-4 8-7 8-7 8-8 8-8 8-8 8-8 8-8 8-8 8-8 8-9 8-9 8-9 8-9 8-9 8-9 8-9 8 - 10 8 - 10 8 - 10 8 - 10 8 - 10 8 - 12 8 - 12 8 - 13 8 - 14 8 - 14 8 - 14 8 - 14 8 - 14 8 - 15 8 - 15 11 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Alpha Numeric Keyboard with cables (FRU P/N: 5315106) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 16 Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 16 Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 16 Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 16 Removal procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 16 Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 16 Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 17 Optical Trackball Assy (FRU P/N: 5315029) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 18 Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 18 Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 18 Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 18 Removal procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 18 Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 18 Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 19 Keyboard Rear Cover Assy (FRU P/N: 5315122) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 20 Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 20 Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 20 Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 20 Removal procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 20 Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 21 Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 21 Probe Holder (FRU P/N: 5168500) / Gel Bottle Holder (FRU P/N: 5168636) 8 - 22 Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 22 Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 22 Removal procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 22 Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 22 Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 22 Keyboard Knob Set (FRU P/N: 5315502 ) & Encoder set (FRU P/N: 5262796) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 23 Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 23 Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 23 Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 23 Removal procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 23 Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 23 Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 23 Mechanicals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 24 RH Side Cover (FRU No :5315115) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 24 Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 24 Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 24 Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 24 Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 24 Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 25 Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 25 LH Side Cover (FRU No: 5315114) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 26 Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 26 Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 26 Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 26 12 Table of Contents GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rear Cover (FRU No. 5315117) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Front Cover (FRU No.5315116 ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Top Cover (FRU P/N: 5315121) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Caster Wheel Front (FRU P/N :5315118 - LP3, 5368246 - LP3BT10) / Caster Wheel Rear (FRU P/N: 5315119 - LP3, 5368247 - LP3 BT10) . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rear EMI Cover (Part of EMI Cover Assy FRU P/N: 5315111) . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Right EMI Cover (Part of EMI Cover Assy FRU P/N: 5315111) . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table of Contents 8 - 26 8 - 26 8 - 26 8 - 27 8 - 27 8 - 27 8 - 27 8 - 27 8 - 28 8 - 28 8 - 29 8 - 29 8 - 29 8 - 29 8 - 29 8 - 30 8 - 31 8 - 32 8 - 32 8 - 32 8 - 32 8 - 32 8 - 34 8 - 34 8 - 35 8 - 35 8 - 35 8 - 35 8 - 35 8 - 35 8 - 35 8 - 36 8 - 36 8 - 36 8 - 36 8 - 36 8 - 36 8 - 36 8 - 37 8 - 37 8 - 37 8 - 37 8 - 37 8 - 37 8 - 38 13 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Left EMI Cover (Part of EMI Cover Assy FRU P/N: 5315111) . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 39 Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 39 Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 39 Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 39 Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 39 Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 40 Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 40 MST BOARD ASSEMBLY ( P/N: 5315025 - LP3, 5388844 - LP3BT10) SOM (P/N: 5308994 - LP3, 5308994 - LP3Bt10) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 41 Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 41 Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 41 Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 41 Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 41 Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 45 Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 45 HARD DISK DRIVE ASSEMBLY ( PART NO:5315113) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 46 Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 46 Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 46 Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 46 Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 46 Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 47 Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 47 USB Cable Set (FRU P/N: 5315039) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 48 Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 48 Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 48 Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 48 Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 48 Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 48 LV and Power distribution Board (Part No: 5315028) / Power distribution Board Assembly (Part no :5315104) - LOGIQ P3 . . . . . 8 - 49 Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 49 Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 49 Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 49 Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 49 Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 50 Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 50 Power distribution Board Assembly (P/N: 5370455), PDB Sub (P/N: 5370323), PDB Sub (Part no.: 5397797) - LOGIQ P3BT10 . . . . 8 - 51 Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 51 Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 51 Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 51 Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 51 Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 52 Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 52 FAN Assy (FRU No.: 5314414) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 53 Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 53 Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 53 14 Table of Contents GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rear Panel Assy (110V FRU P/N: 5315503/ 220V FRU P/N: 5315504) LOGIQ P3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Connector Board Assy 3PP (FRU No. 5314411) / Connector Board Assy 2PP (FRUNo. 5314412) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TX Board (FRU No. 2404903)/ Flex Cable (Con to Tx) Assy (FRU No.5315108) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RX Board (FRU P/N: 5315027) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Flexi Cable (MST to TX) Assy (FRU No.5315109) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Block - LOGIQ P3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Transformer Assembly (FRU No. 5196448) Cable Guard Clamp (FRU No:5219747) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table of Contents 8 - 53 8 - 53 8 - 53 8 - 54 8 - 54 8 - 54 8 - 54 8 - 54 8 - 55 8 - 56 8 - 57 8 - 57 8 - 57 8 - 57 8 - 57 8 - 59 8 - 60 8 - 61 8 - 61 8 - 61 8 - 61 8 - 61 8 - 62 8 - 62 8 - 63 8 - 63 8 - 63 8 - 63 8 - 63 8 - 64 8 - 65 8 - 66 8 - 66 8 - 66 8 - 66 8 - 66 8 - 67 8 - 68 8 - 69 8 - 69 8 - 69 8 - 69 8 - 69 15 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 69 Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 71 Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 71 Power Block - LOGIQ P3 BT10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 72 Power Entry Module (FRU No: 5397502) Cable Guard (FRU No: 5389807) 8 - 72 Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 72 Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 72 Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 72 Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 72 Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 73 Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 73 Key Caps (FRU P/N: 5315124) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 74 Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 74 Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 74 Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 74 Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 74 Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 75 Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 75 DVD Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 76 DVD Tray Assembly (FRU P/N: ) / DVD Drive ( FRU P/N: 5312274) . . . . . 8 - 76 Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 76 Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 76 Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 76 Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 76 Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 76 Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 76 Power Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 77 Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 77 Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 77 Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 77 Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 77 Mounting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 77 Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 78 Video Interface Board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 79 Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 79 FRU BOM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 79 Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 79 Preparation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 79 Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 79 Mounting Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 79 Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 79 Signal Cable Set (FRU P/N: 5315042) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 80 Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 80 FRU BOM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 80 Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 80 Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 80 Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 80 16 Table of Contents GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Cable Set (FRU P/N: 5315036). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FRU BOM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CWD Assy (FRU No: 5315026 ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Needed Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 81 8 - 82 8 - 82 8 - 82 8 - 82 8 - 82 8 - 82 8 - 83 8 - 84 8 - 84 8 - 84 8 - 84 8 - 84 8 - 85 Loading Base Image Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Initiate Software reload from the Common Service Desktop . . . . . . Initiate software reload from the Recovery Console . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . For a service call with no fru replacement, use the following debrief script. 8 - 86 8 - 89 8 - 90 8 - 91 8 - 91 Table of Contents 17 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL CHAPTER 9 Renewal Parts Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 1 Purpose of Chapter 9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 1 List of Abbreviations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 2 Operator Console Assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 3 ................................................................. LCD Assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 4 Keyboard Assy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 5 Keyboard key caps FRU part no:- 5315124 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 6 Mechanical Assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 8 Pwa Assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 11 Pwa assy (cont’d) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 12 Flex PCB Cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 13 Signal Cable Set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 14 USB Cable set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 16 Power Cable Set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 17 Accessories and Kits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 19 Probe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 21 Logiq P3 FRU List With Part Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 22 18 Table of Contents GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL CHAPTER 10 Care & Maintenance Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 1 Periodic Maintenance Inspections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 1 Purpose of Chapter 10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 1 Why do Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 2 Keeping Records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 2 Quality Assurance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 2 Maintenance Task Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 2 How often should care & maintenance tasks be performed? . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 2 Tools Required . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Standard GE Tool Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Special Tools, Supplies and Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Specific Requirements for Care & Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 4 10 - 4 10 - 6 10 - 6 System Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preliminary Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional Checks (See Also Chapter 4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . System Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Peripheral/Option Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Input Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AC Power Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . General Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Physical Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Optional Diagnostic Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . View the Logs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Probe Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Probe Related Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Basic Probe Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Basic Probe Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 7 10 - 7 10 - 8 10 - 8 10 - 9 10 - 9 10 - 9 10 - 9 10 - 9 10 - 10 10 - 11 10 - 11 10 - 11 10 - 11 10 - 11 10 - 11 Using a Phantom . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 12 Electrical Safety Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Safety Test Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . GEMS Leakage Current Limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Outlet Test - Wiring Arrangement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Grounding Continuity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Meter Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table of Contents 10 - 12 10 - 12 10 - 13 10 - 14 10 - 15 10 - 15 19 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Dale 600 - Ground Continuity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 16 Chassis Leakage Current Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 17 Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 17 Generic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 17 Dale 600 Meter Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 18 Data Sheet for enclosure Source Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 19 Isolated Patient Lead (Source) Leakage–Lead to Ground . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 19 Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 19 Generic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 20 Dale 600 Meter Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 20 Isolated Patient Lead (Source) Leakage–Lead to Lead . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 22 Dale 600 Patient Lead Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 22 Isolated Patient Lead (Sink) Leakage-Isolation Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 22 Data Sheet for ECG Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 23 Probe Leakage Current Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 24 Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 24 Test Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 24 Generic Procedure for Leakage current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 26 Meter Procedure Using Dale Meter to Measure Leakage Current . . 10 - 26 Meter Procedure Using Probe Adaptor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 27 Data Sheet for Transducer Source Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 28 When There's Too Much Leakage Current... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 29 20 Table of Contents GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Chapter 1 Introduction Section 1-1 Overview 1-1-1 Purpose of Chapter 1 This chapter describes important issues related to safely servicing this ultrasound machine. The service provider must read and understand all the information presented here before installing or servicing a unit. 1-1-2 Chapter Contents Table 1-1 Contents in Chapter 1 Section 1-1-3 Description Page Number 1-1 Overview 1-1 1-2 Important Conventions 1-4 1-3 Safety Considerations 1-10 1-4 EMC, EMI, and ESD 1-19 1-5 Customer Assistance 1-20 Purpose of Proprietary Manual This Proprietary Manual provides service information for the LOGIQ P3/LOGIQ P3 BT10 Ultrasound Scanning Systems. It contains the following chapters: 1.) Chapter 1 - Introduction: Contains a content summary and warnings. 2.) Chapter 2 - Pre Installation: Contains pre-installation requirements for the LOGIQ P3/LOGIQ P3 BT10. 3.) Chapter 3 - Installation: Contains installation procedures. 4.) Chapter 4 - Contains functional checks that are recommended as part of the installation, or as required during servicing and periodic maintenance. 5.) Chapter 5 - Components and Functions (Theory): Contains block diagrams and functional explanations of the electronics. 6.) Chapter 6 - Service Adjustments: Contains instructions on how to make available adjustments to the LOGIQ P3. 7.) Chapter 7 - Diagnostics/Troubleshooting: Provides procedures for running diagnostic or related routines for the LOGIQ P3/LOGIQ P3 BT10. 8.) Chapter 8 - Replacement Procedures: Provides disassembly procedures and reassembly procedures for all changeable Field Replaceable Units (FRU). 9.) Chapter 9 - Renewal Parts: Contains a complete list of field replaceable parts for the LOGIQ P3/ LOGIQ P3 BT10. 10.)Chapter 10 - Care & Maintenance: Provides periodic maintenance procedures for the LOGIQ P3/ LOGIQ P3 BT10. Chapter 1 Introduction 1-1 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 1-1-4 Typical Users of the Basic Service Manual • 1-1-5 Service Personnel (installation, maintenance, etc.). • Hospital’s Service Personnel • Contractors (Some parts of Chapter 2 - Pre-Installation) LOGIQ P3 Models Covered by this Manual Table 1-2 LOGIQ P3 Model Designations Part Number 1-2 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Description 5313969 Logiq P3 EXP System INDIA 230V 5313973 Logiq P3 PRO System INDIA 230V 5313974 Logiq P3 BW System INDIA 230V 5313976 Logiq P3 EXP System JAPAN 100V 5313977 Logiq P3 PRO System JAPAN 100V 5313978 Logiq P3 BW System JAPAN 100V 5313979 Logiq P3 EXP System CHINA 230V 5313980 Logiq P3 PRO System CHINA 230V 5313981 Logiq P3 BW System CHINA 230V 5313982 Logiq P3 EXP System CHILE/KOREA 230V 5313983 Logiq P3 PRO System CHILE/KOREA 230V 5313984 Logiq P3 BW System CHILE/KOREA 230V 5313985 Logiq P3 EXP System EUROPE 230V 5313986 Logiq P3 PRO System EUROPE 230V 5313987 Logiq P3 BW System EUROPE 230V 5313988 Logiq P3 EXP System AMERICAS 110V 5313989 Logiq P3 PRO System AMERICAS 110V 5313990 Logiq P3 BW System AMERICAS 110V 5313991 Logiq P3 EXP System AMERICAS with Higher UI height 5313992 Logiq P3 PRO System AMERICAS with Higher UI height 5313993 Logiq P3 BW System AMERICAS with Higher UI height Section 1-1 - Overview GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 1-1-6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL LOGIQ P3 BT10 Models Table 1-3 LOGIQ P3 BT10 Model Designations Part Number 1-1-7 Description 5368255 Logiq P3 EXP System INDIA 230V 5400135 Logiq P3 PRO System INDIA 230V 5400136 Logiq P3 BW System INDIA 230V 5400137 Logiq P3 EXP System CHINA 230V 5400138 Logiq P3 PRO System CHINA 230V 5400139 Logiq P3 BW System CHINA 230V 5400140 Logiq P3 EXP System CHILE/KOREA 230V 5400141 Logiq P3 PRO System CHILE/KOREA 230V 5400142 Logiq P3 BW System CHILE/KOREA 230V 5400143 Logiq P3 EXP System EUROPE 230V 5400144 Logiq P3 PRO System EUROPE 230V 5400145 Logiq P3 BW System EUROPE 230V 5400146 Logiq P3 EXP System AMERICAS 110V 5400147 Logiq P3 PRO System AMERICAS 110V 5400148 Logiq P3 BW System AMERICAS 110V Purpose of Operator Manual(s) The Operator Manual(s) should be fully read and understood before operating the LOGIQ P3 and also kept near the unit for quick reference. Chapter 1 Introduction 1-3 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 1-2 Important Conventions 1-2-1 Conventions Used in Book Icons Pictures, or icons, are used wherever they reinforce the printed message. The icons, labels and conventions used on the product and in the service information are described in this chapter. Safety Precaution Messages Various levels of safety precaution messages may be found on the equipment and in the service information. The different levels of concern are identified by a flag word that precedes the precautionary message. Known or potential hazards are labeled in one of following ways: DANGER DANGER IS USED TO INDICATE THE PRESENCE OF A HAZARD THAT WILL CAUSE SEVERE PERSONAL INJURY OR DEATH IF THE INSTRUCTIONS ARE IGNORED. WARNING WARNING IS USED TO INDICATE THE PRESENCE OF A HAZARD THAT CAN CAUSE SEVERE PERSONAL INJURY AND PROPERTY DAMAGE IF INSTRUCTIONS ARE IGNORED. CAUTION Caution is used to indicate the presence of a hazard that will or can cause minor personal injury and property damage if instructions are ignored. NOTICE Equipment Damage Possible Notice is used when a hazard is present that can cause property damage but has absolutely no personal injury risk. Example: Disk drive will crash. NOTE: 1-4 Notes provide important information about an item or a procedure. Information contained in a NOTE can often save you time or effort. Section 1-2 - Important Conventions GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 1-2-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Standard Hazard Icons Important information will always be preceded by the exclamation point contained within a triangle, as seen throughout this chapter. In addition to text, several different graphical icons (symbols) may be used to make you aware of specific types of hazards that could cause harm. Table 1-4 Standard Hazard Icons ELECTRICAL MECHANICAL LASER HEAT RADIATION LASER LIGHT Other hazard icons make you aware of specific procedures that should be followed. Table 1-5 Standard Icons Indicating a Special Procedure Be Used AVOID STATIC ELECTRICITY TAG AND LOCK OUT WEAR EYE PROTECTION TAG & LOCKOUT Signed EYE PROTECTION Date Chapter 1 Introduction 1-5 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 1-2-3 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Product Icons The following table describes the purpose and location of safety labels and other important information provided on the equipment. Table 1-6 Warnings LABEL/SYMBOL PURPOSE/MEANING LOCATION Identification and Rating Plate • Manufacture’s name • Date of manufacture See ‘Identification and Rating Plate’ on • Model and serial numbers page1-6 for more information. • Electrical ratings (Volts, Amps, phase, and frequency) Type/Class Label Used to indicate the degree of safety or protection. IP Code (IPX1 or IPX8) Indicates the degree of protection Bottom of Footswitch provided by the enclosure per IEC60 529. IPX1 cannot be used in operating room environment; IPX8 can be used in operating room environment. Equipment Type BF (man in the box symbol) IEC 878-02-03 indicates B Type equipment having a floating applied part. Probe and PCG marked Type BF ATTENTION - Consult accompanying documents is intended to alert the user to refer to the operator manual or other Various instructions when complete information cannot be provided on the label. “CAUTION - Dangerous voltage” (the lightning flash with arrowhead in equilateral triangle) is used to indicate electric shock hazards. Rear panel and inside of console “Mains OFF” indicates the power off position of the mains power breaker. See the Console Overview section for location information. “Mains ON” indicates the power on position of the mains power breaker. See the Console Overview section for location information. “ON” indicates the power on position of See the Console Overview section for the power switch. location information. CAUTION: This Power Switch DOES NOT ISOLATE Mains Supply. “Standby” indicates the power standby position of the power switch. CAUTION: This Power Switch DOES NOT ISOLATE Mains Supply. “Protective Earth” indicates the protective earth (grounding) terminal. 1-6 Section 1-2 - Important Conventions Internal GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Table 1-6 Warnings LABEL/SYMBOL PURPOSE/MEANING LOCATION “Equipotentiality” indicates the terminal Rear of console to be used for connecting equipotential conductors when interconnecting (grounding) with other equipment. Connection of additional protective earth conductors or potential equalization conductors is not necessary in most cases and is only recommended for situations involving multiple equipment in a high-risk patient environment to provide assurance that all equipment is at the same potential and operates within acceptable leakage current limits. An example of a highrisk patient would be a special procedure where the patient has an accessible conductive path to the heart such as exposed cardiac pacing leads. Alternating Current symbol is in accordance with IEC 60878-01-14. Rear Panel, Rating Plate, Circuit breaker label of console and front panel (if applicable). Date of manufacture. The date could be a year, year and month, or year, month and day, as appropriate. See ISO 8601 for date formates. Rating Plate Catalog or model number. Rating Plate Serial number Rating Plate Direct Current. For products to be powered from a DC Rating Plate supply. Type CF Defib-Proof Applied Part (heart ECG Module in the box with paddle) symbolis in accordance with IEC 60878-02-06. Chapter 1 Introduction 1-7 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Table 1-6 Warnings LABEL/SYMBOL PURPOSE/MEANING LOCATION This symbol indicates that the waste of electrical and electronic equipment must not be disposed as unsorted municipal waste and must be collected Rating Plate separately. Please contact an authorized representative of the manufacturer for information concerning the decommissioning of your equipment. No hazardous substance, above the maximum concentration value, is present. Maximum concentration values for electronic information products, as set by the People’s Republic of China Electronic Industry Standard SJ/T11364-2006, include the hazardous substances of lead, mercury, hexavalent chromium, cadmium, polybrominated biphenyl (PBB), and polybrominated diphenyl ether (PBDE). Indicates the presence of hazardous Rear Panel substance(s) above the maximum concentration value. Maximum concentration values for electronic information products, as set by the People’s Republic of China Electronic Industry Standard SJ/T11364-2006, include the hazardous substances of lead, mercury, hexavalent chromium, cadmium, polybrominated biphenyl (PBB), and polybrominated diphenyl ether (PBDE). “20” indicates the number of years during which the hazardous substance(s) will not leak or mutate so that the use of this product will not result in any severe environmental pollution, bodily injury, or damage to any assets. DO NOT place a finger, hand or any object on the joint of the monitor or monitor arm to avoid injury when moving the monitor and monitor arm. Do not use the following devices near this equipment: cellular phone, radio receiver, mobile radio transmitter, radio controlled toy, broadband power lines, etc. Use of these devices near this equipment could cause this equipment to perform outside the published specifications. Keep power to these devices turned off when near this equipment. 1-8 Section 1-2 - Important Conventions Rear of the LCD monitor GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Table 1-6 Warnings LABEL/SYMBOL PURPOSE/MEANING LOCATION “CAUTION This unit weighs 80 kgs. Special care must be taken to avoid injury.” This precaution is intended to prevent injury that may result if one person attempt to move the unit considerable distances or on an incline due to the weight of the unit. On the console where easily seen during This product consists of devices that Rear of LCD may contain mercury, which must be recycled or disposed of in accordance with local, state, or country laws. (Within this sytem, the backlight lamps in the monitor display, contain mercury.) “Consult accompanying document” is Rear cover intended to alert the user to refer to the operator manual or other instructions when complete information cannot be provided on the label. Chapter 1 Introduction 1-9 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 1-3 Safety Considerations 1-3-1 Introduction The following safety precautions must be observed during all phases of operation, service and repair of this equipment. Failure to comply with these precautions or with specific warnings elsewhere in this manual, violates safety standards of design, manufacture and intended use of the equipment. 1-3-2 Human Safety Operating personnel must not remove the system covers. Servicing should be performed by authorized personnel only. Only personnel who have participated in a LOGIQ P3 Training are authorized to service the equipment. 1-3-3 Mechanical Safety WARNING Ultrasound probes are highly sensitive medical instruments that can easily be damaged by improper handling. Use care when handling and protect from damage when not in use. Do not use a damaged or defective probe. Failure to follow these precautions can result in serious injury and equipment damage. WARNING Never use a probe that has fallen to the floor. Even if it looks ok, it may be damaged. CAUTION The LOGIQ P3 weights 80kg or more, depending on installed peripherals, when ready for use. To avoid possible injury and equipment damage: ALWAYS: NOTE: 1-10 • Use the handle to move the system. • Do not let the system strike walls or door frame. • Limit movement to a slow careful walk. Special care should be taken when transporting the unit in a vehicle: • Before transporting, place the system in its special storage case. • Ensure that the system is firmly secured while inside the vehicle. • Secure system with straps or as directed otherwise to prevent motion during transport. • Prevent vibration damage by driving cautiously. Avoid unpaved roads, excessive speeds, and erratic stops or starts. • Push the system with needed force to move over a threshold. Section 1-3 - Safety Considerations GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 1-3-4 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Electrical Safety To minimize shock hazard, the equipment chassis must be connected to an electrical ground. The system is equipped with a three-conductor AC power cable. This must be plugged into an approved electrical outlet with protective ground. The power outlet used for this equipment should not be shared with other types of equipment. Both the system power cable and the power connector meet international electrical standards. 1-3-5 Labels Locations Figure 1-1 Label Location for LOGIQ P3 Chapter 1 Introduction 1-11 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 1-3-5 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Labels Locations (cont’d) Figure 1-2 Label Location for LOGIQ P3 1-12 Section 1-3 - Safety Considerations GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 1-3-5 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Labels Locations (cont’d) Figure 1-3 Label Location for LOGIQ P3 Chapter 1 Introduction 1-13 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 1-3-5 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Labels Locations (cont’d) Figure 1-4 1-14 Section 1-3 - Safety Considerations GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Figure 1-5 Chapter 1 Introduction 1-15 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Figure 1-6 Labels (LOGIQ P3 BT10) 1-16 Section 1-3 - Safety Considerations GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 1-3-6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Warning labels location Table L1 (Figure 1-2) D1: Standard LCD monitor may rotate while transporting. Bind the system securely to prevent damage in transportation. D2: To avoid injury by tipping over, DO NOT PUSH THIS UNIT FROM THE SIDES. D3: DO NOT place a finger, hand or any object on the joint of the monitor or monitor arm to avoid injury when moving the monitor and monitor arm.Placing objects on top of the monitor may cause the monitor to tilt with the falling objects resulting in injury to the operator. Do not place any objects on the monitor. L2 (Figure 1-2) D4: This machine should be used in compliance with law. Some jurisdictions restrict certain uses, such as gender determination. L3 (Figure 1-3) D5: Identification and Rating Plate. L4 (Figure 1-4) D6: “Consult accompanying document” is intended to alert the user to refer to the operator manual or other instructions when complete information cannot be provided on the label. Possible shock hazard. Do not remove covers or panels. No user serviceable parts are inside. Refer servicing to qualified service personnel. D7: Do not use the following devices near this equipment: cellular phone, radio receiver, mobile radio transmitter, radio controlled toy, etc. Use of these devices near this equipment could cause this equipment to perform outside the published specifications. Keep power to these devices turned off when near this equipment. D8: Caution: Federal law restricts this device to sale or use by or on the order of a physician. D9: The CE Mark of Conformity indicates this equipment conforms with the Council Directive 93/ 42/EEC D10: CISPR CAUTION: The <systemFont>LOGIQ P3 conforms to the CISPR11, Group 1, Class A of the international standard for Electromagnetic disturbance characteristics. D11: WEEE Label: This symbol indicates that the waste of electrical and electronic equipment must not be disposed as unsorted municipal waste and must be collected separately. Please contact an authorized representative of the manufacturer for information concerning the decommissioning of your equipment. D12: The equipment weighs approximately 80 kg (176 lbs). To avoid possible injury and equipment damage when transporting from one area of use to another: • Be sure the pathway is clear.• Limit movement to a slow careful walk.• Use two or more persons to move the equipment on inclines or long distance. L5 (Figure 1-4) D13: EIAJ Label (Japan Only). L6 (Figure 1-4) D14: Gost Label (Russia Only). L7 (Figure 1-5) D15: TUV Label: TUV Listing and Certification Mark is used to designate conformance to nationally recognized product safety standards. The Mark bears the name and/or logo of the testing laboratory, product category, safety standard to which conformity is assessed, and a control number L8 (Figure 1-5) D16: Circuit breaker Label L9 (Figure 1-5) D17: Line Input voltage Label. L10 (Figure 1-5) D18: Signal ground point label CAUTION: This is only for “FUNCTIONAL GROUNDING”, NOT “PROTECTIVE EARTH”. L11 (Figure 1-5) Lamp contains Mercury Dispose According to Stete/ Local Law. Chapter 1 Introduction 1-17 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 1-3-7 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Dangerous Procedure Warnings Warnings, such as the examples below, precede potentially dangerous procedures throughout this manual. Instructions contained in the warnings must be followed. DANGER DANGEROUS VOLTAGES, CAPABLE OF CAUSING DEATH, ARE PRESENT IN THIS EQUIPMENT. USE EXTREME CAUTION WHEN HANDLING, TESTING AND ADJUSTING. WARNING EXPLOSION WARNING DO NOT OPERATE THE EQUIPMENT IN AN EXPLOSIVE ATMOSPHERE. OPERATION OF ANY ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT IN SUCH AN ENVIRONMENT CONSTITUTES A DEFINITE SAFETY HAZARD. WARNING DO NOT SUBSTITUTE PARTS OR MODIFY EQUIPMENT BECAUSE OF THE DANGER OF INTRODUCING ADDITIONAL HAZARDS, DO NOT INSTALL SUBSTITUTE PARTS OR PERFORM ANY UNAUTHORIZED MODIFICATION OF THE EQUIPMENT. WARNING SHUT DOWN FORCEDLY OR PLUG IN/OUT ACDC INVALID MAY CAUSE THE DAMAGE OF SYSTEM FILES. 1-3-8 Lockout/Tagout Requirements (For USA Only) Follow OSHA Lockout/Tagout requirements by ensuring you are in total control of the electrical Mains plug. 1-3-9 Returning/Shipping Probes and Repair Parts Equipment being returned must be clean and free of blood and other infectious substances. GEMS policy states that body fluids must be properly removed from any part or equipment prior to shipment. GEMS employees, as well as customers, are responsible for ensuring that parts/equipment have been properly decontaminated prior to shipment. Under no circumstance should a part or equipment with visible body fluids be taken or shipped from a clinic or site (for example, body coils or an ultrasound probe). The purpose of the regulation is to protect employees in the transportation industry, as well as the people who will receive or open this package. NOTE: The US Department of Transportation (DOT) has ruled that “items that were saturated and/or dripping with human blood that are now caked with dried blood; or which were used or intended for use in patient care” are “regulated medical waste” for transportation purposes and must be transported as a hazardous material. NOTE: The USER/SERVICE staff should dispose all the waste properly as per federal, state, and local waste disposal regulation. 1-18 Section 1-3 - Safety Considerations GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 1-4 EMC, EMI, and ESD 1-4-1 Electromagnetic Compatibility (EMC) Electromagnetic compatibility describes a level of performance of a device within its electromagnetic environment. This environment consists of the device itself and its surroundings including other equipment, power sources and persons with which the device must interface. Inadequate compatibility results when a susceptible device fails to perform as intended due interference from its environment or when the device produces unacceptable levels of emission to its environment. This interference is often referred to as radio–frequency or electromagnetic interference (RFI/EMI) and can be radiated through space or conducted over interconnecting power of signal cables. In addition to electromagnetic energy, EMC also includes possible effects from electrical fields, magnetic fields, electrostatic discharge and disturbances in the electrical power supply. 1-4-2 CE Compliance The LOGIQ P3 unit conforms to all applicable conducted and radiated emission limits and to immunity from electrostatic discharge, radiated and conducted RF fields, magnetic fields and power line transient requirements. For applicable standards refer to the Safety Chapter in the Basic User Manual. NOTE: 1-4-3 WARNING For CE Compliance, it is critical that all covers, screws, shielding, gaskets, mesh, clamps, are in good condition, installed tightly without skew or stress. Proper installation following all comments noted in this service manual is required in order to achieve full EMC performance. Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Prevention DO NOT TOUCH ANY BOARDS WITH INTEGRATED CIRCUITS PRIOR TO TAKING THE NECESSARY ESD PRECAUTIONS: 1. ALWAYS CONNECT YOURSELF, VIA AN ARM-WRIST STRAP, TO THE ADVISED ESD CONNECTION POINT LOCATED ON THE REAR OF THE SCANNER (TO THE RIGHT OF THE POWER CONNECTOR). 2. FOLLOW GENERAL GUIDELINES FOR HANDLING OF ELECTROSTATIC SENSITIVE EQUIPMENT. Chapter 1 Introduction 1-19 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 1-5 Customer Assistance 1-5-1 Contact Information If this equipment does not work as indicated in this proprietary manual or in the User Manual, or if you require additional assistance, please contact the local distributor or appropriate support resource, as listed below. Prepare the following information before you call: - System ID serial number. - Software version. Table 1-3 Phone Numbers for Customer Assistance Location USA GE Healthcare Ultrasound Service Engineering 9900 Innovation Drive Wauwatosa, WI 53226 Phone Number Service: On-site 1-800–437–1171 Service: Parts 1-800-321-7937 Applications support 1-800-682-5327 or 1-262-524-5698 Canada 1-800-668-0732 Service 1-800-321-5300 Applications support 1-262-524-5698 Latin America Europe GE Ultraschall Deutschland GmbH& Co. KG BeethovenstraBe 239 Postfach 11 05 60, D-42665 Solingen Germany Phone: +49 (0)212-2802-652 (-OLC) +33-1-3083-1300 (English/German all segments incl. training) Fax: +49 (0)212-2802-431 Asia (Singapore) Asia ultrasound tech support GE Ultrasound Asia ANZ +(61) 1800-647-855 Service Department - Ultrasound China +(86) 800-810-8188 298 Tiong Bahru Road #15-01/06 India +(91) 1-800-425-8085 Central Plaza Korea +(82) 2-1544-6119 Singapore 169730 SEA +(65) 6277-3444 Japan Support Center 1-20 OLC - EMEA Phone: 81-42-648-2940 Fax: 81-42-648-2905 Section 1-5 - Customer Assistance GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 1-5-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL System Manufacturer Table 1-4 System Manufacturer Manufacturer Wipro GE Healthcare Pvt Ltd No:4, Kadugodi Industrial Area, Bangalore, Karnataka, INDIA - 560067. TEL: 91-80-41801000 FAX: 91-80-28452924 Chapter 1 Introduction 1-21 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL This page was intentionally left blank. 1-22 Section 1-5 - Customer Assistance GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Chapter 2 Pre Installation Section 2-1 Overview 2-1-1 Purpose of this chapter 2 This chapter provides the information required to plan and prepare for the installation of a LOGIQ P3. Included are descriptions of the facility and electrical needs to be met by the purchaser of the unit. 2-1-2 Chapter Contents Table 2-1 Contents in Chapter 2 Section Description Page Number 2-1 Overview 2-1 2-2 General Console Requirements 2-2 2-3 Facility Needs 2-7 Chapter 2 Pre Installation 2-1 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 2-2 General Console Requirements 2-2-1 Console Environmental Requirements Table 2-2 Environmental Requirements for LOGIQ P3 Scanners Operational Storage Transport (<16 hrs.) 10 - 40 degrees C -10 to 70 degrees C -40 to 70 degrees C 50-104 degrees F 14- to 158 degrees F -40 to 158 degrees F Humidity 30 - 85% non-condensing 30 -90% non-condensing 30 - 90% non-condensing Pressure 700 - 1060hPa 700 - 1060hPa 700 - 1060hPa Temperature Temperatures in degree C, conversion to degree F = (degree C*(9/5) + 32) Table 2-3 Environmental Requirements for an Ultrasound Room Item Values Power Source Radiation Shielding Temperature Humidity Floor Landing Floor Condition 2-2-1-1 NONE REQUIRED for ULTRASOUND ENERGY 20-26 DEG. C (68-79 DEG F) for PATIENT COMFORT 50% to 70% for PATIENT COMFORT Heat Dissipation Weight Refer to Table on page 2-3. 1366 BTU/Hr. Approximately 680 - 800 kg/m2 without Accessories Gradient: WITHIN 5 degrees 80 kg (176lbs) without Accessories Cooling The cooling requirement for the LOGIQ P3 is 1366 BTU/hr. This figure does not include cooling needed for lights, people, or other equipment in the room. Each person in the room places an additional 300 BTU/hr. demand on the cooling system. 2-2-1-2 Lighting Bright light is needed for system installation, updates and repairs. However, operator and patient comfort may be optimized if the room light is subdued and indirect. Therefore a combination lighting system (dim/bright) is recommended. Keep in mind that lighting controls and diameters can be a source of EMI which could degrade image quality. These controls should be selected to minimize possible interface. 2-2 Section 2-2 - General Console Requirements GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 2-2-2 NOTE: PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Electrical Requirements GE Healthcare requires a dedicated power and ground for the proper operation of its Ultrasound equipment. This dedicated power shall originate at the last distribution panel before the system. Sites with a mains power system with defined Neutral and Live: The dedicated line shall consist of one phase, a neutral (not shared with any other circuit), and a full size ground wire from the distribution panel to the Ultrasound outlet. Sites with a mains power system without a defined Neutral: The dedicated line shall consist of one phase (two lines), not shared with any other circuit, and a full size ground wire from the distribution panel to the Ultrasound outlet. Please note that image artifacts can occur, if at any time within the facility, the ground from the main facility's incoming power source to the Ultrasound unit is only a conduit. 2-2-2-1 LOGIQ P3 Power Requirements Table 2-4 Electrical Specifications for LOGIQ P3 PARAMETER AREA LIMITS 100-120V 100 VAC ± 10% (90-110 VAC) 220-240V 230 VAC ±10% (207-253 VAC) Voltage Range (LOGIQ P3 BT10) 100-240V ±10% Power All applications MAX. 425VA Line Frequency All applications 50/60Hz (±2Hz) Power Transients All applications Less than 25% of nominal peak voltage for less than 1 millisecond for any type of transient, including line frequency, synchronous, asynchronous, or aperiodic transients. Decaying Oscillation All applications Less than 15% of peak voltage for less than 1 millisecond. Voltage Range (LOGIQ P3) Chapter 2 Pre Installation 2-3 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 2-2-2-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Inrush Current Inrush current is not a factor to consider due to the inrush current limiting properties of the power supplies. 2-2-2-3 Site Circuit Breaker It is recommended that the branch circuit breaker for the machine be readily accessible. 2-2-2-4 Site Power Outlets A dedicated AC power outlet must be within reach of the unit without extension cords. Other adequate outlets for the external peripherals, medical and test equipment needed to support this unit must also be present within 1 m (3.2 ft.) of the unit. Electrical installation must meet all current local, state, and national electrical codes. 2-2-2-5 Unit Power Plug If the unit arrives without a power plug, or with the wrong plug, you must contact your GE dealer or the installation engineer must supply what is locally required. 2-2-2-6 Power Stability Requirements Voltage drop-out Max 10 ms. Power Transients (All applications) Less than 25% of nominal peak voltage for less than 1 millisecond for any type of transient, including line frequency, synchronous, asynchronous, or aperiodic transients. 2-4 Section 2-2 - General Console Requirements GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 2-2-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL EMI Limitations Ultrasound machines are susceptible to Electromagnetic Interference (EMI) from radio frequencies, magnetic fields, and transient in the air wiring. They also generate EMI. The LOGIQ P3 complies with limits as stated on the EMC label. However there is no guarantee that interface will not occur in a particular installation. Possible EMI sources should be identified before the unit is installed. Electrical and electronic equipment may produce EMI unintentionally as the result of defect. These sources include: • medical lasers • scanners • cauterizing guns • computers • monitors • fans • gel warmers • microwave ovens • light dimmers • portable phones • Lift The presence of a broadcast station or broadcast van may also cause interference. See Table 2-5 for EMI Prevention tips. Table 2-5 EMI Prevention/abatement EMI Rule Details Be aware of RF sources Keep the unit at least 5 meters or 15 feet away from other EMI sources. Special shielding may be required to eliminate interference problems caused by high frequency, high powered radio or video broadcast signals. Ground the unit Poor grounding is the most likely reason a unit will have noisy images. Check grounding of the power cord and power outlet. Replace all screws, RF gaskets, covers, cores After you finish repairing or updating the system, replace all covers and tighten all screws. Any cable with an external connection requires a magnet wrap at each end. Install the shield over the front of card cage. Loose or missing covers or RF gaskets allow radio frequencies to interfere with the ultrasound signals. Replace broken RF gaskets If more than 20% or a pair of the fingers on an RF gasket are broken, replace the gasket. Do not turn on the unit until any loose metallic part is removed. Do not place labels where RF Never place a label where RF gaskets meet the unit. Otherwise, the gap created will permit gaskets touch metal RF leakage. Or, if a label has been found in such a position, move the label. Use GE specified harnesses and peripherals The interconnect cables are grounded and require ferrite beads and other shielding. Also, cable length, material, and routing are all important; do not change from what is specified. Take care with cellular phones Cellular phones may transmit a 5 V/m signal; that could cause image artifacts. Properly dress peripheral cables Do not allow cables to lie across the top of the card cage or hang out of the peripheral bays. Loop the excess length for peripheral cables inside the peripheral bays. Attach the monitor cables to the frame. Chapter 2 Pre Installation 2-5 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 2-2-4 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Scan Probe Environmental Requirements Operation:10° to 40° C Storage: 10° to 60° C Storage: 10° to 70° C (LOGIQ P3 BT10) NOTE: Temperature in degrees C. Conversion to Degrees F = (Degrees C * (9/5) + 32). NOTICE SYSTEMS AND ELECTRONIC PROBES ARE DESIGNED FOR STORAGE TEMPERATURES OF -20 TO + 50 degrees C. WHEN EXPOSED TO LARGE TEMPERATURE VARIATIONS, THE PRODUCT SHOULD BE KEPT IN ROOM TEMPERATURE FOR 10 HOURS BEFORE USE. 2-2-5 Time and Manpower Requirements Site preparation takes time. Begin Pre-installation checks as soon as possible. If possible, allow six weeks before delivery, for enough time to make necessary changes. CAUTION 2-6 Have two people available to deliver and unpack the LOGIQ P3/LOGIQ P3 BT10. Attempts to move the unit considerable distances or on an incline by one person could result in injury or damage or both. Section 2-2 - General Console Requirements GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 2-3 Facility Needs 2-3-1 2-3-1-1 Recommended Ultrasound Room Layout Purchaser Responsibilities The work and materials needed to prepare the site is the responsibility of the purchaser. Delay, confusion, and waste of manpower can be avoided by completing pre installation work before delivery. User the Pre Installation checklist to verify that all needed steps have been taken, Purchaser reasonability includes: NOTE: • Procuring the materials required. • Completing the preparations before delivery of the ultrasound system. • Paying the costs for any alternations and modifications not specifically provided in the sales contract. All electrical installation that are preliminary to the positioning of the equipment at the site prepared for the equipment must be performed by licensed electrical contractors. Other connections between pieces of electrical equipment, products involved (and the accompanying electrical installations) are highly sophisticated and special engineering competence is required. All electrical work on these product must comply with the requirements of applicable electrical codes. The purchaser of GE equipment must only utilize qualified personnel to perform electrical servicing on the equipment. The desire to use a non-listed or customer provided product or to place an approved product further from the system than the interface kit allows presents challenges to the installation team. To avoid delays during installation, such variances should be made known to the individuals or group performing the installation at the earliest possible date (preferable prior to purchase). The ultrasound suite must be clean prior to delivery of the machine. Carpet is not recommended because it collects dust and creates static. Potential sources of EMI (electromagnetic interference) should also be investigated before delivery. Dirt, static, and EMI can negatively impact system. Chapter 2 Pre Installation 2-7 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 2-3-2 NOTE: PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Required Features GE Health Care Systems requires a dedicated power and ground for the proper operation of its Ultrasound equipment. This dedicated power shall originate at the last distribution panel before the system. Sites with a mains power system with defined Neutral and Live: The dedicated line shall consist of one phase, a neutral (not shared with any other circuit), and a full size ground wire from the distribution panel to the Ultrasound outlet. Sites with a mains power system without a defined Neutral: The dedicated line shall consist of one phase (two lines), not shared with any other circuit, and a full size ground wire from the distribution panel to the Ultrasound outlet. Please note that image artifacts can occur, if at any time within the facility, the ground from the main facility's incoming power source to the Ultrasound unit is only a conduit. 2-3-3 2-8 • Dedicated single branch power outlet of adequate amperage meeting all local and national codes which is located less than 2.5 m (8 ft.) from the unit’s proposed location • Door opening is at least 76 cm (30 in) wide • Proposed location for unit is at least 0.3m (1 ft.) from the wall for cooling • Power outlet and place for any external peripheral are within 2 m (6.5 ft.) of each other with peripheral within 1 m of the unit to connect cables. • Power outlets for other medical equipment and gel warmer • Power outlets for test equipment and modem within 1 m (3.2 ft.) of unit • Clean and protected space to store transducers (in their cases or on a rack) • Material to safely clean probes (done with a plastic container, never metal) Desirable Features • Door is at least 92 cm (3 ft.) wide • Circuit breaker for dedicated power outlet is easily accessible • Sink with hot and cold water • Receptacle for bio–hazardous waste, like used probe sheaths • Emergency oxygen supply • Storage for linens and equipment • Nearby waiting room, lavatory, and dressing room • Dual level lighting (bright and dim) • Lockable cabinet ordered by GE for its software and proprietary manuals. Section 2-3 - Facility Needs GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 2-3-3-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Recommended and Alternate Ultrasound Room Layout Recommended standard floor plan and a minimal floor plan for ultrasound equipment: Figure 2-1 RECOMMENDED ULTRASOUND ROOM LAYOUT Chapter 2 Pre Installation 2-9 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 2-3-4 2-3-4-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Networking Pre-installation Requirements Stand Alone Scanner (without Network Connection) None. 2-3-4-2 Scanner Connected to Hospital’s Network Supported networks: 2-3-4-3 Purpose of DICOM Network Function DICOM services provide the operator with clinically useful features for moving images and patient information over a hospital network. Examples of DICOM services include the transfer of images to workstations for viewing or transferring images to remote printers. As an added benefit, transferring images in this manner frees up the on-board monitor and peripherals, enabling viewing to be done while scanning continues. With DICOM, images can be archived, stored, and retrieved faster, easier, and at a lower cost. 2-3-4-4 DICOM Option Pre-installation Requirements To configure the LOGIQ P3 to work with other network connections, the site’s network administrator must provide some necessary information. Information must include: 2-10 • A host name, local port number, AE Title, IP address and Net Mask for the LOGIQ P3. • The IP addresses for the default gateway and other routers at the site for ROUTING INFORMATION. • The host name, IP address, port and AE Title for each device the site wants connected to the LOGIQ P3 for DICOM APPLICATION INFORMATION. A field for the make (manufacturer) and the revision of the device, is also included. This information may be useful for solving errors. Section 2-3 - Facility Needs GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 2-3-4-4 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL DICOM Option Pre-installation Requirements (cont’d) . LOGIQ P3 Host Name Local Port AE Title ROUTING INFORMATION IP Address . . . Net Mask . . . GATEWAY IP Addresses Destination IP Addresses Default . . . ROUTER1 . . . . . . ROUTER2 . . . . . . ROUTER3 . . . . . . DICOM APPLICATION INFORMATION NAME MAKE/REVISION AE TITLE IP ADDRESSES PORT Store 1 . . . Store 2 . . . Store 3 . . . Store 4 . . . Store 5 . . . Store 6 . . . Worklist . . . Storage Commit . . . . . . MPPS Figure 2-2 Worksheet for DICOM Network Information Chapter 2 Pre Installation 2-11 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL This page was intentionally left blank. 2-12 Section 2-3 - Facility Needs GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Chapter 3 Installation Section 3-1 Overview 3-1-1 Purpose of Chapter 3 This chapter contains information needed to install the unit. Included are references to a procedure that describes how to receive and unpack the equipment and how to file a damage or loss claim. How to prepare the facility and unit of the actual installation, and how to check and test the unit, probes, and external peripherals for electrical safety are included in this procedure. Also included in this section are guidelines for transporting the unit to a new site. Table 3-1 Contents in Chapter 3 Section Page Number 3-1 Overview 3-1 3-2 Receiving and Unpacking the Equipment 3-3 3-3 Packing the Equipment 3-8 3-4 Preparing for Installation 3-9 3-5 Completing the Installation 3-10 3-6 System Configuration 3-15 Software/Option Configuration 3-27 3-7 Connectivity Installation Worksheet 3-28 3-8 Loading Base Image Software 3-29 3-9 Software Version check out 3-30 3-10 Paperwork 3-31 3-6-7 3-1-2 Description Average Installation Time Table 3-2 Average Installation Time Description Average Installation Time Unpacking the scanner Approximately 0.5 hour Scanner /options Approximately 0.5 hour DICOM Option 30 minutes Comments Dependent on the configuration that is required Dependent on the amount of configuration The LOGIQ P3 installation and functional checkout will take approximately Four hour. LOGIQ P3 consoles with optional equipment may take slightly longer. Chapter 3 Installation 3-1 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 3-1-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Installation Warnings 11.)Since the LOGIQ P3 weighs approximately 80 kg (176 lbs) without options, preferably two people should unpack it. Two people are also preferable for installing any additional bulky items. 12.)There are no operator serviceable components. To prevent shock, do not remove any covers or panels. Should problems or malfunctions occur, unplug the power cord. Only qualified service personnel should carry out servicing. NOTE: For information regarding packing labels, refer to LABELS ON PACKAGE. 13.)After being transported, the unit may be very cold or hot. If this is the case, allow the unit to acclimate before you turn it on. It requires one hour for each 2.5×C increment it's temperature is below 10×C or above 40×C. DANGER Equipment damage possibility. Turning the system on without acclimation after arriving at site may cause the system to be damaged. Table 3-3 Time for Settlement °C 60 55 50 45 40 35 30 25 20 15 10 5 0 -5 -10 -15 -20 -25 -30 -35 -40 °F 140 131 122 113 104 96 86 77 68 59 50 41 32 23 14 5 -4 -13 -22 -31 -40 hrs 8 6 4 2 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 3-1-4 DANGER Safety Reminders WHEN USING ANY TEST INSTRUMENT THAT IS CAPABLE OF OPENING THE AC GROUND LINE (I.E., METER’S GROUND SWITCH IS OPEN), DON’T TOUCH THE UNIT! CAUTION If the unit is very cold or hot, do not turn on its power until it has had a chance to acclimate to its operating environment. DANGER To prevent electrical shock, connect the unit to a properly grounded power outlet. Do not use a three to two prong adapter. This defeats safety grounding. DANGER Do not operate this unit unless all board covers and frame panels are securely in place.System performance and cooling require this. DANGER OPERATOR MANUAL(S) The User Manual(s) should be fully read and understood before operating the LOGIQ P3 and kept near the unit for quick reference. DANGER ACOUSTIC OUTPUT HAZARD Although the ultrasound energy transmitted from the LOGIQ P3 probe is within FDA limits, avoid unnecessary exposure. Ultrasound energy can produce heat and mechanical damage 3-2 Section 3-1 - Overview GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 3-2 Receiving and Unpacking the Equipment When a new system arrives, check that any components are not damaged and are not in short supply. If shipping damage or shortage occurs, contact the address shown in Chapter 1. The Packaging/Unpacking Procedure. Topics discussed in the Packaging/Unpacking Procedure: 1.) Check the Shipment 2.) Unpack the Unit 3.) Handling Incomplete or Damaged Shipment Please read these procedures before packing/unpacking the LOGIQ P3. We strongly advice you to store the LOGIQ P3 packing material in undamaged condition in case of future transportation. CAUTION Do not lift the unit by the Keyboard. This may cause equipment damage. CAUTION The crate with the LOGIQ P3 weighs approximately 80 kg. Be prepared for a sudden shift of weight as the unit is removed from its base (pallet). CAUTION Inspect the Shcik watch and Tilt watch. Ensure that they are not fused. (Refer to the instructions attached on the packing Box on howto check the Shcik watch and Tiltwatch) 1.) Cut the two Metal Bands. Figure 3-1 Cutting the two metal bands. Chapter 3 Installation 3-3 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 Section 3-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Receiving and Unpacking the Equipment (cont’d) 2.) Lift the TOP Cover up and off. Figure 3-2 Remove the top cover 3.) Remove the Monitor Cap up and off... Monitor Cap Figure 3-3 Removing the Monitor Cap 3-4 Section 3-2 - Receiving and Unpacking the Equipment GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 Section 3-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Receiving and Unpacking the Equipment (cont’d) 4.) Remove the three Plastic Joints from the Outer Sleeve. (Refer to the Labels on the Packing Box for more detailed instructions) 5.) Remove the Outer Sleeve. 6.) Remove the Inner Sleeve. Inner Sleeve Plastic Joint Palette Assy Figure 3-4 Removing Plastic Joints and Sleeves Chapter 3 Installation 3-5 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 Section 3-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Receiving and Unpacking the Equipment (cont’d) 7.) Remove the Plastic Wrapping around the LOGIQTM P3. 8.) Remove the Monitor Support and Monitor Packing. 9.) Remove the adhesive tapes attached at the four corners of the Top Cover. 10.)Put the Ramp Board on floor and prepare the slope to put the console down. 11.)Unlock the brakes on the front castors, then carefully put the console off the Palette. Figure 3-5 Removing System from the Pallete 3-6 Section 3-2 - Receiving and Unpacking the Equipment GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 Section 3-2 NOTE: PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Receiving and Unpacking the Equipment (cont’d) Check the shipping container for special instructions. Verify that the container is intact. In some cases a secondary container may be used. If so, ask the carrier for unpacking instructions. Figure 3-6 Labels on Package CAUTION Please carefully unpack the system, and do not dispose the package of LOGIQ P3, so that it can be reused for service. 3-2-1 Moving into Position CAUTION Do not lift the unit by the keyboard. Use handle to move system.Do not tilt the unit more than 5 degrees to avoid tipping it over. CAUTION Equipment Damage Possibility. Lifting the console by holding covers may damage the covers. Do not lift the console by holding any covers. In general, a single adult can move the LOGIQ P3 along an even surface with no steep grades. At least two people should move the machine when large humps, grooves, or grades are encountered. (It is better to pull from the rear rather than push from the front of the unit). Before moving, store all loose parts in the unit. Wrap transducers in soft cloth or foam to prevent damage. Although LOGIQ P3 is a compact and mobile machine, two people should move it over rough surfaces or up and down grades. 3-2-2 Adjusting System Clock Set the system clock for the LOGIQ P3 to the local time. For procedure of adjusting the system clock, refer to 4-5 Software Configuration Checks, in Chapter 4, FUNCTIONAL CHECKS. Chapter 3 Installation 3-7 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 3-2-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Product Locator Installation Card Fill out proper customer Information on the Product Locator Installation Card. Mail this Installation Card “Product Locator” to the address corresponding to your pole. NOTE: The Product Locator Installation Card shown may not be same as the provided Product Locator card. Figure 3-7 PRODUCT LOCATOR INSTALLATION CARD Section 3-3 Packing the Equipment Please pack LOGIQ P3 in the reverse order of unpacking. 3-8 Section 3-3 - Packing the Equipment GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 3-4 Preparing for Installation 3-4-1 Verify Customer Order Compare items received by the customer to that which is listed on the delivery order. Report any items that are missing, back ordered or damaged. 3-4-2 3-4-2-1 Physical Inspection System Voltage Settings • WARNING 3-4-3 Verify that the scanner is set to the correct voltage. The Voltage ratings for the LOGIQ P3 Scanner is found on Rating label near the Circuit Breaker at the rear of the system Connecting a LOGIQ P3 scanner to the wrong voltage level will most likely destroy the scanner. EMI Protection This Unit has been designed to minimize the effects of Electro Magnetic Interference (EMI). Many of the covers, shields, and screws are provided primarily to protect the system from image artifacts caused by this interference. For this reason, it is imperative that all covers and hardware are installed and secured before the unit is put into operation. 3-4-4 Checking the Components When a new system arrives, check that none of the components are damaged or in short supply. If shipping damage or shortage occurs, contact the address shown in Chapter 1. CAUTION If the Power Plug is Modified or replaced to Suit the local Conditions and regulations, Ground C continuity check should be performed between Ground Pin on the Plug and the Metal Part on the LOGIQ P3. Refer Section 10-7 for more details. Chapter 3 Installation 3-9 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 3-5 Completing the Installation 3-5-1 NOTE: 3-5-1-1 Power On / Boot Up After turning off a system, wait at least twenty seconds before turning it on again. The system may not be able to boot if power is recycled too quickly. Scanner Power On 1.) Connect the Power Cable to the back of the system. 2.) Ensure the Cable Clip slips securely over the shoulders on the molded plug. 3.) Connect the Main Power Cable to a hospital grade power receptacle with the proper rated voltage. Never use an adapter that would defeat the safety ground. 4.) Switch ON the Circuit Breaker at the rear of the system. a b Figure 3-9 Scanner Power On a. Circuit Breaker b. Power Cable When power is applied to the scanner and the rear Circuit Breaker is turned ON, power is distributed to the Transformer Assembly and to the TMST. 3-10 Section 3-5 - Completing the Installation GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 3-5-1-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Turn on the system Press the Power On/Off switch at the front of the system once. Power On/Off switch Figure 3-10 Power On/Off Switch When the Power On/Off switch on the Control Panel is pressed once, the TMST starts and the software code is distributed to initiate the scanner. No status messages are displayed during this process. 3-5-2 NOTE: 3-5-2-1 Power Off/ Shutdown After turning off a system, wait at least twenty seconds before turning it on again. The system may not be able to boot if power is recycled too quickly. Back-end Processor Power Down - LOGIQ P3 To power down the system: 1.) Press the Power On/Off switch at the front of the system. 2.) The System-Exit window is displayed. Figure 3-11 System Exit Window 3.) Using the Trackball or Select key, select Shutdown. 4.) The shutdown process takes a few seconds and is complete when the power status LED is turned Amber color. 5.) Disconnect the probes.Clean or disinfect all probes as necessary. Store them in their shipping cases to avoid damage. Chapter 3 Installation 3-11 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 3-5-2-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Back-end Processor Power Down - LOGIQ P3 BT10 To power down the system: 1.) Press the Power On/Off switch at the front of the system. 2.) Thew System-Exit window is displayed. Figure 3-12 System Exit Window 3.) Using the Trackball or Select key, select Shutdown. 4.) The shutdown process takes a few seconds and is complete when the power status LED is turned Amber color. 5.) Disconnect the probes. Clean or disinfect all probes as necessary. Store them in their shipping cases to avoid damage. 3-12 Section 3-5 - Completing the Installation GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 3-5-2-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Scanner Shutdown a b Figure 3-13 Scanner Shutdown 1.) Switch OFF the Circuit Breaker at the back of the system. 2.) Disconnect the Mains Power Cable if necessary. For example: Relocating the scanner. 3-5-3 Transducer Connection 1.) Connect a transducer to the upper transducer receptancle as follows: A.) Ensure that the transducer twist lock lever points horizontally. B.) Insert the transducer connector on the receptacle guide pin until it touches the receptacle mating surface. C.) Twist the transducer lock lever vertically to lock it in place. D.) Twist the lever to the horizontal position to disconnect the transducer. Chapter 3 Installation 3-13 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 NOTE: PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Please ensure that the probe latch is in unlocked position before you connect the probe to the system. Fig (A) Connecting the Probe Fig (B) Locking the Probe Lever Figure 3-14 Connect the probe NOTE: 3-14 It is not necessary to turn OFF power to connect or disconnect a probe. Section 3-5 - Completing the Installation GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 3-6 System Configuration 3-6-1 3-6-1-1 System Specifications Physical Dimensions The physical dimensions of the LOGIQ P3 console are summarized in Table 3-16. Table 3-4 Physical Dimensions of LOGIQ P3 Height Width Depth Unit 1347 445 595 mm 53.0 17.5 23.4 inches Figure 3-15 Overall Dimensions 3-6-2 Approved peripherals Table 3-5 Approved peripherals Device Manufacturer Model H Cat Interface B/W Printer SONY UP-D897 H44492LB USB Digital Color Printer SONY UP-D23MD H4903JT USB HP HP Officejet Pro K550 H47052LW USB HP HP Laser Jet P2015dn ---------------- USB HP HP Office jet Pro K5400 --------------- USB HP HP Office jet 6000 --------------- USB HP HP Deskjet 460 ---------------- USB HP HP 4360 ----------------- USB HP HP 6940 ---------------- USB 3-pedal footswitch Steute MKF 2-MED GP26 H47042LY USB USB Memory Transcend Transcend ---------------- USB ECG NORAV ECG-USB1 H47042LJ USB DVR Panasonic LQ-MD800 ----------------- S-Video,USB USB HDD Iomega USB HDD 160GB ----------------- USB HP Color Printer (LOGIQ P3 BT10) HP HP 470 ..................... Bluetooth Bluetooth Dongle (LOGIQ P3 BT10) HP BT 500 ---------------- Bluetooth HP Color Printer Chapter 3 Installation 3-15 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 3-6-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Connecting Cables WARNING Equipment damage possibility. Be sure to use the following recommended connecting cables to connect recording devices and a network with LOGIQ P3 console. Table 3-6 List of Connecting Cables Name 3-6-4 Figure NOTE USB Cable For USB ECG (3feet) USB Cable For USB Printer (3feet) Peripherals/Accessories Connector Panel LOGIQ P3 peripherals and accessories can be properly connected using the Rear panel. 3-6-4-1 Rear Panel Connector Located on the Rear panel are USB Ports, VGA,S-Video,Composite Out, ethernet port & Power out let. Figure 3-16 Rear Panel NOTE: LOGIQ P3 BT10 - The printers must be connected only to the first USB port (a). NOTE: LOGIQ P3 BT10 - The USB dongle for Bluetooth wireless printer can be connected to any USB port available in the system except the USB port (a). 3-16 Section 3-6 - System Configuration GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Table 3-7 LOGIQ P3 & LOGIQ P3 BT10 LOGIQ P3 LOGIQ P3 BT10 A) USB ports for printers & ECG (B/W, Color and USB), Memory Stick, Footswitch, DVD-RW, USB HDD. NOTE: 3-6-4-2 a) USB ports for printers & ECG (B/W, Color and USB), Memory Stick, Footswitch, DVD-RW, USB HDD. B) Ethernet port b) ECG (B/W, Color and USB), Memory Stick, Footswitch, DVD-RW, USB HDD C) VGA Output c) Ethernet port D) S-Video Out d) VGA Output E) Composite video out e) S-Video Out F) Power outlet f) Composite video out For the printer, bluetooth supports line of sight of approximately 10 mts. TOP Panel Connector Located on the Top Right side panel are one USB Port for control connections for printer, USB Thumb Drive and service tools.) Figure 3-17 Left Side Panel NOTICE The USB devices should be connected to LOGIQ P3 first, power on USB devices before turning LOGIQ P3 to work. NOTE: Each outer (case) ground line of peripheral/accessory connectors are protectively grounded. NOTE: Please scan the devices (USB Pen Drive, HDD etc,...) for virus - before using it with the system. Chapter 3 Installation 3-17 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 3-6-4-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL This section indicates the pin assignment for each connector. 1. S- Video Connector: 4 Pin, mini-Din Table 3-8 S-Video Connector, 4 Pin Pin No Output Signal Description Picture 1 SVIDEO OUT/IN YG Y (Luma) GND 2 SVIDEO OUT/IN CG C (Chroma) GND 3 SVIDEO OUT/IN Y Y (Luma) SIGNAL 4 SVIDEO OUT/IN C C (Chroma) SIGNAL 2. Pin Assignment of USB Table 3-9 Pin assignment of USB1 Pin No. Signal Pin No. Signal 1 +5VDC 3 DATA+ 2 DATA- 4 GND Table 3-10 Pin assignment of USB2 3-18 Pin No. Signal Pin No. Signal 1 +5VDC 3 DATA+ 2 DATA- 4 GND Section 3-6 - System Configuration GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 3-6-4-4 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Connect peripherals 1.) Connecting B/W printer UP-D897 or Color printer UP-D23MD to the system. Only B/W Printer UP-D897 can be mounted in Front Utility area tray as shown in figure below. Fig (B) Fig (A) VGP Tray Bottom VGP Tray top Using two Captive fastener mount VGP Tray bottom to the Sytem Utility box. Figure 3-18 Connect B/W printer Tray to the system 2.) Mount the Sony UP-D897 printer to the VGP-UP-D 897-Mounting-Bracket using Four M3 x 8 screws as indicated below. Chapter 3 Installation 3-19 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 A PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL A B A Rear Side of the printer. B Front side of the Printer A B B VGP-UP897-Mounting-Bracket(5314101) A - Indicates the location of the mounting holes on the VGP-UP-D897-Mounting-Bracket B - Indicates the location of the mounting holes on the Printer Rear Side of the Printer Front Side Of the Printer Mounting the bracket to the printer by using M3X8 Screws Figure 3-19 Mounting of VGP Tray to Printer 3.) Insert or Slide the Sony UP-D897 B/W Printer with Bracket (Out come of Step A) in to the Tray fixed on the System and than connect USB & Power cables in the rear side o fthe printer and push back fully & Tighten the Front captive fastener as indicated in below fig. 3-20 Section 3-6 - System Configuration GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Figure 3-20 Mounting The Sony UPD 897 on LOGIQ P3. 4.) Mounting Procedure for Color printer UP-D23MD: Connect the USB Cable to any of the usb ports available on rear panel & connect the power cable to the rear panel Power port. 5.) Connecting Foot Switch to the system: Foot Switch USB cable can be connected to any USB Ports of the LOGIQ P3 system in the rear panel. Chapter 3 Installation 3-21 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 3-6-4-4 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Connect peripherals (cont’d) USB Ports Foot switch Figure 3-21 Connect Foot Switch to the system 6.) Connecting S-Video cable to the system: S-Video O/P is available on rear panel. 7.) Connect the USB Memory stick to the system: The USB Memory stick must be connected to top panel USB port or in any of the Rear panel USB Ports. Figure 3-22 USB Memory Connection 8.) Connecting the USB HDD to the system: The USB Harddisk can be properly connected to Rear Panel USB ports. 9.) Connecting the DVR to the system: The S-Video signal, USB Cable & power cable can be properly connected using the S-Video port,USB Ports & Power Port in the Rear panel. To activate DVR assign DVR to any of the F6 to F12 keys in Utility>admin>functional key & again Utility >System>peripherals select the respective DVR Model.Than press the respective funtion key to record the Image 3-22 Section 3-6 - System Configuration GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL . S-Video Cable in USB Cable Power Cable Figure 3-23 DVR Connection on the rear panel 10.)Connecting the Color printer HP Laser jet P2015/ HP Officejet Pro K550/K5400/4360/6940 to the system: The USB Cable & power cable can be properly connected to the USB Ports & Power Port in the Rear panel. Configure the printer from Config>Connectivity>Service>Standard print, select the respective printer. Power Cable USB Cable USB Cable Figure 3-24 Color Printer Connection on the rear panel Chapter 3 Installation Power cable 3-23 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 11.)Connecting the external monitor to the system: The monitor must be properly connected using the VGA port in the Rear panel. Press Ctrl+Alt+V on the keyboard, a dialog box appears. Figure 3-25 Graphics Controller Properties Select Intel(R) Dual Display Clone; check the Same display configuration driver on both display box and select OK. 12.)Connecting USB Bluetooth Printers (LOGIQ P3 BT10): Connect one USB bluetooth dongle to the LOGIQ P3 BT10 system and another USB bluetooth dongle to the HP printer and configure the printer in the Utility screen. Figure 3-26 LOGIQ P3 BT10 Printer Connection NOTE: Please refer to the User manual of each peripheral for information needed by the user to operate the system safely. NOTE: For the printer, bluetooth supports approximately within 10 mts. line of sight. NOTE: If the software is reloaded, you must pair between the bluetooth dongles (printer bluetooth dongle and th system dongle). 3-24 Section 3-6 - System Configuration GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 3-6-5 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Configuring the Bluetooth Printer After loading the software, follow the steps below to configure the Bluetooth Printer. 1.) Select Start on the Taskbar 2.) Select Bluetooth 3.) Select My Bluetooth 4.) Select Entire Bluetooth Neighborhood The device will search for the Bluetooth Printer. 5.) Select HP Officejet 6.) Select pair device 7.) Enter 0000 (four zeroes), the security code 8.) Select OK NOTE: Wait for few seconds till the check mark is seen on the printer. 9.) Select Print properties 10.)Print Test page 11.)Select Start ---> Bluetooth Assign standard print to any of the print keys. Refer User Manual. Chapter 3 Installation 3-25 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 3-6-6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Available Probes See in specification in the LOGIQ P3 User Reference Manual for Probes and intended use. Table 3-11 List of Probes for LOGIQ P3 Probe Name Area of Using TYPE Catalog Number Part Number 4C GENERAL PURPOSE CONVEX H4904PC 5123455 MICRO-CONVEX H40412LE 2294641 MICRO-CONVEX H44801HR 47236865 E8C E8CS TRANSVAGINAL TRANSRECTAL TRANSVAGINAL TRANSRECTAL 8C Abdomen, OB/GYN, Urology MICRO-CONVEX H40412LJ 2348094 11L Vascular, Small Parts, Musculoskeletal, Masso sonography LINEAR H40412LY 5171885 8L SMALL PARTS PERIPHERAL VASCULAR LINEAR H4001DB 5140738 3S Cardiac, Transcranial SECTOR H4701SZ 2323337 5cs Abdomen, OB/GYN, Urology CONVEX H4001DC 5143934 t739 INTRAOPERATIVE LINEAR H40212LM 2259246 The following probes are included for LOGIQ P3 BT10 along with the above probes: 3-26 7.5LA SMALL PARTS PERIPHERAL VASCULAR LINEAR H48282LA 5334811 6S Cardiac, Pediatric SECTOR H45021RS 47236867 3.5CA GENERAL PURPOSE CONVEX H48282LB 5334810 Section 3-6 - System Configuration GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 3-6-7 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Software/Option Configuration Refer to the LOGIQ P3 Basic User Manual, Chapter 16, Customizing Your System for information on configuring items like Hospital, Department, Language, Units (of measure), Date, Time and Date Format. For information on configuring Software Options, Refer to the LOGIQ P3 Basic User Manual, Chapter 16, Customizing Your System. For information on configuring DICOM Connectivity, Refer to the LOGIQ P3 Basic User Manual, Chapter 16, Customizing Your System. NOTE: After enabling the Software Option, do a Full Maintenance Reboot. (LOGIQ P3) NOTE: After enabling the Software Option, you must Shutdown and Reboot. (LOGIQ P3 BT10) Chapter 3 Installation 3-27 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 3-7 Connectivity Installation Worksheet Site System Information Comments: Floor: Site: Dept: Room: Type: LOGIQ SN: REV: CONTACT INFORMATION Name Title Phone E-Mail Address TCP/IP Settings Name - AE Title: IP Settings Remote Archive Setup IP Address: Remote Archive IP: Subnet Mask: Remote Archive Name: Default Gateway: Services (Destination Devices) Device Type Manufacturer Name IP Address Port 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 3-28 Section 3-7 - Connectivity Installation Worksheet AE Title GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 3-8 Loading Base Image Software This information has been moved, please refer to: Section 8-14 "Loading Base Image Software" on page 8-86 NOTE: The Base and Application DVD are single DVD. Chapter 3 Installation 3-29 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 3-9Software Version check out 3-9-1 Functional Check-out 1.) Power on LOGIQ P3 scanner and wait until system booting to main screen. 2.) Press UTILITY key on control panel. 3.) Choose the About button on the right. Figure 3-27 About 4.) Check whether "Software version" is the right version for use. Figure 3-28 Software version 3-30 Section 3-9 - Software Version check out GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 3-10 Paperwork NOTE: 3-10-1 NOTE: During and after installation, the documentation (i.e. User Manuals, Installation Manuals...) for the peripheral units must be kept as part of the original system documentation. This will ensure that all relevant safety and user information is available during the operation and service of the complete system. Product Locator Installation The Product Locator Installation Card shown may not be same as the provided Product Locator card. Figure 3-29 Product Locator Installation Card 3-10-2 User Manual(s) User Check that the correct User Manual(s) for the system and software revision, is included with the installation. Specific language versions of the User Manual may also be available. Check with your GE Sales Representative for availability. Chapter 3 Installation 3-31 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 3-32 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 3-10 - Paperwork GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Chapter 4 Functional Checks Section 4-1 Overview 4-1-1 Purpose for Chapter 4 This chapter provides procedures for quickly checking major functions of the LOGIQ P3 console, diagnostics by using the built-in service software, and power supply adjustments. Section Description Page Number 4-1 Overview 4-1 4-2 Required Equipment 4-1 4-3 General Procedure 4-2 4-4 Software Configuration Checks 4-37 4-5 Peripheral Checks 4-37 Table 4-1 Contents in Chapter 4 Section 4-2 Required Equipment To perform these tests, you'll need any of the sector, linear, or convex transducers. (normally you should check all the transducers used on the system) Chapter 4 Functional Checks 4-1 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 4-3 General Procedure CAUTION SYSTEM REQUIRES ALL COVERS Operate this unit only when all board covers and frame panels are securely in place. The covers are required for safe operation, good system performance and cooling purposes. NOTICE Lockout/Tagout Requirements (For USA only) Follow OSHA Lockout/Tagout requirements by ensuring you are in total control of the Power Cable on the system. TAG & LOCKOUT Signed Date 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up After AC power cable is connected correctly to the transformer & Circiut breaker is switched on, the power is applied to the scanner & the system is in Stand By mode. In the Control panel Power On/Off key will be Amber color. 4-3-1-1 Boot Up In the control Panel press the power On/Off key the led color will turn in Green color & the system will boot. a b Figure 4-1 Connect AC adapter LOGIQ P3 A. Circuit Breaker B. Power Cable 4-2 LOGIQ P3 BT10 a. Circuit Breaker b. Power Cable Section 4-3 - General Procedure GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-1-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Boot Up (cont’d) When power is applied to the scanner, power is distributed to the Cooling Unit, Control Panel, LCD, Peripherals and the TMST. 4-3-1-2 Turn on the system Press the Power On/Off switch at the front of the system once. Power On/Off switch Figure 4-2 Power On/Off Switch When the Power On/Off switch on the Control Panel is pressed once, the TMST starts and the software code is distributed to initiate the scanner. No status messages are displayed during this process. 4-3-2 NOTE: 4-3-2-1 Power Off/ Shutdown After turning off a system, wait for at least twenty seconds before turning it on again. The system may not be able to boot if power is recycled too quickly. TMST Power Down To power down the system: 1.) Press the Power On/Off switch at the front of the system once. 2.) The System-Exit window is displayed. Figure 4-3 System Exit Window 3.) Using the Trackball or Select key, select Shutdown. Chapter 4 Functional Checks 4-3 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-2-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL TMST Power Down (cont’d) 4.) The shutdown process takes 15 seconds and the power off sequence is complete when the power status LED is turned Amber. 5.) Disconnect the probes.Clean or disinfect all probes as necessary. Store them in their shipping cases to avoid damage. 4-3-2-2 Scanner Shutdown Disconnect the Mains Power Cable is necessary. For example: Relocating the scanner. CAUTION DO NOT unplug and/or transport the unit until after the power off sequence has been completed. Failure to do so may result in corrupted patient files. 4-3-2-3 Full Maintenance Reboot (LOGIQ P3) Full Maintenance Reboot will fully restart the whole system for performance improvement. 1.) Press the Power On/Off switch at the front of the system once. 2.) Click “Shutdown”. 3.) Full Maintenance Reboot dialog is displayed. Figure 4-3 “Full Maintenance Reboot” dialog 4.) During Full Maintenance the pop up window will two options “Ok” and “Cancel” press cancel for Normal shutdown (Hibernate) and Ok for Shutdown. 4-4 Section 4-3 - General Procedure GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-3 NOTE: PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Archiving and Loading Presets Always save presets before any software reload. This ensures the presets loaded after the software reload are as up–to–date as possible. All user presets except changes to Summary, Anatomy, and Biometry pages, can be saved on an DVDR disk (or USB memory device) for reloading on the system. NOTICE Presets should NOT be saved on the same DVD-R disk (or USB memory device) as images. The Archive Menu lists the images but does NOT list the presets stored on a DVD-R disk (or USB memory device). 4-3-3-1 Archiving Presets to a DVD-R Disk (or USB memory device) 1.) Insert an empty (blank) DVD-R disk into the DVD Drive. 2.) Access to the Utility Menu, and select System. The Backup sheet will be shown on the LCD display. Figure 4-4 Backup Sheet 3.) Select the item to back up either from Resource Files. 4.) Enter backup destination or browse through the disk to locate the destination. 5.) Select Backup now. The backup status for each item is displayed on the Result column. Chapter 4 Functional Checks 4-5 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-3-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Loading Presets from a DVD-R disk (or USB memory device) 1.) Insert the DVD-R disk with the archived Presets into the DVD Drive. 2.) Access to the Utility Menu, and select System. The Restore sheet will be shown on the LCD display. (see Figure 4-4) 3.) Select the item to restore either from Resource Files. 4.) Enter restore destination or browse through the disk to locate the destination. 5.) Select Restore. The restore status for each item is displayed on the Result column. 4-3-4 Adjusting the Display Monitor Please refer to Section 6-2 "Monitor Adjustments" on page 6-2. 4-6 Section 4-3 - General Procedure GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-5 4-3-5-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL System Features Control Panel Figure 4-5 Control Panel Tour 1.) TGC 2.) New Patient 3.) App selection/Preset Key 4.) Report & End Exam 5.) Imaging/Coments/Clear/Measurement Keys 6.) Mode/Gain/Auto Keys/Zoom/Ellipse 7.) Depth 8.) Left/Right/ATO/THI 9.) Freeze 10.)Reverse 11.)Print Keys 12.)User Defined Keys 13.)A/N Keyboard 14.)Sub Menu Keys 15.)NTUPI/Top Menu Keys Chapter 4 Functional Checks 4-7 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-5-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL LOGIQ P3 SoftMenu Key Tour In general, there are two types of NTPUI/SoftMenu keys: Paddle Switch and adjustable knobs. Figure 4-6 SoftMenu Key Tour 1.) The Paddle Switch is used to access and adjust the Sub SoftMenu. 2.) Press the adjustable knobs to toggle option menu between line one and line two. 3.) Rotate the adjustable knobs to adjust the corresponding parameters. 4-8 Section 4-3 - General Procedure GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-5-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Monitor Display 1 2 3 12 4 5 13 6 7 14 8 15 9 17 10 16 18 11 20 1921 22 23 Figure 4-7 Monitor Display Tour Monitor Display Features 1. Institution/Hospital Name, Date, Time, Operator Identification, system status (real-time of frozen). 13. Imaging Parameters by Mode (current mode highlighted). 2. Patient Name, Patient Identification. 14. Focal Zone. 3. Acoustic Output Readout, 15. TGC (not shown on the image). 4. GE Symbol: Probe Orientation Marker. Coincides with a probe orientation marking on the probe. 16. Body Pattern. 5. Image Preview. 17. Depth Scale. 6. Gray/Color Bar. 18. SoftMenu 7. Cine Gauge. 19. Caps Lock: On/Off. 8. Measurement Summary Window. 20. Start menu icon. 9. Image. 21. Network icon 10. Measurement. 22. Trackball Functionality Status: Scroll, M&A (Measurement and Analysis), Position, Size, Scan Area Width and Tilt. 11. Results Window. 23. Active key for Depth/Zoom/Ellipse 12. Probe Identifier. Exam Study. Chapter 4 Functional Checks 4-9 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL B Mode Checks 4-3-6-1 Preparations 1.) Connect one of the probes listed in 3-6-6 "Available Probes" on page 3-26, in Chapter 3 Installation to the System probe connector. 2.) Turn ON the scanner (if it isn’t turned on already) Secondary Menu Frame Average Biopsy Kit Line Density Focus Width B Softner Suppression Power Output SoftMenu Key Primary Menu Frequency Virtual Convex Gray Map Dynamic Range Rejection Focus Position Colorize Edge Enhance Rotation Focus Number Depth B Mode Freeze Zoom Scan Area Figure 4-8 Controls available in B Mode Figure 4-9 B Mode Screen Picture Example 4-10 Section 4-3 - General Procedure GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-6-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL B Mode OP Panel Controls Table 4-2 B Mode Control Panel Controls Step 1 Task Expected Result(s) Press B Mode key B Mode Starts Adjust Depth Adjust the field of view. Increasing the depth may view larger/deeper structures rates, and decreasing the depth may view near the skin line.Press Up/Down Button to increase/ decrease. Depth displays on the monitor in cm. Adjust Gain Controls the amount of echo information displayed in an image. Turn B Mode dial to the left/right to increase/decrease Gain. Gain displays on the monitor in G (dB). Adjust Focus Increases the number of focal zones or moves the focal zone(s) to tighten up the beam for specific area. Press the control to toggle between Focus Position and Focus Number. Press Up/Down Button to move or adjust the focal numbers. Activate Auto Optimize Optimize the image based upon a specified region of interest or anatomy. Press the Center Button in the Gain Dial to toggle the ATO/ACE On and Off. Adjust Time Gain Compensation (TGC) Amplifies the returning signals to correct for the attenuation caused by tissues at increasing depth. TGC slide pots spaced proportional to the depth. Move the slide pots to the left/right to decrease/increase TGC. A TGC curve appears on the display. 8 Adjust Scan Area Widen or narrow the size of the sector angle to maximize the image’s region of interest (ROI). Press Scan Area and move the Trackball to narrow/widen the angle. 9 Adjust Zoom Changes the location of the focal point(s). A triangular focus marker indicates the depth of the focal point. 10 Reverse Toggles the left/right orientation of the scan image. 2 3 4 5 7 Chapter 4 Functional Checks 4-11 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-6-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL B Mode Softmenu Key Table 4-3 B Mode Softmenu Key Step Expected Result(s) 1 Adjust Rejection Selects a level below which echoes will not be amplified (an echo must have a certain minimum amplitude before it will be processed). 2 Activate Colorize Enables gray scale image colorization. To deactivate, reselect a Gray Map. 3 Adjust Edge Enhance Edge Enhance brings out subtle tissue differences and boundaries by enhancing the gray scale differences corresponding to the edges of structures. Adjustments to M Mode's edge enhancement affects the M Mode only. 4 Activate Gray Map Determines how the echo intensity levels received are presented as shades of gray. 5 Adjust Frequency Multi Frequency mode lets you downshift to the probe's next lower frequency or shift up to a higher frequency. 6 Adjust Frame Average Temporal filter that averages frames together. This has the effect of presenting a smoother, softer image. 7 Adjust Rotation Rotates the image by selecting the value from the pop-up menu. 9 Adjust Line Density Optimizes B Mode frame rate or spatial resolution for the best possible image. Power output Optimizes image quality and allows user to reduce beam intensity. 2% increments between 0-100%. Values greater than 0.1 are displayed. Dynamic Range Dynamic Range controls how echo intensities are converted to shades of gray, thereby increasing the adjustable range of contrast. 12 Focus Number and Position Increases the number of transmit focal zones or moves the focal zone(s) so that you can tighten up the beam for a specific area. A graphic caret corresponding to the focal zone position(s) appears on the right edge of the image. 13 Virtual Convex Virtual Convex for linear probe 10 11 4-12 Task Section 4-3 - General Procedure GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-7 4-3-7-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL M Mode Controls Preparations 1.) Connect one of the probes listed in 3-6-6 "Available Probes" on page 3-26, in Chapter 3 Installation to the System probe connector. 2.) Turn ON the scanner (if it isn’t turned on already). Secondary Menu Primary Menu Power Output Dynamic Range Sweep Speed Display Format Full Timeline Colorize Edge Enhance Rejection Anatomical M Gray Map Gain M cursor M Mode Figure 4-10 Controls available in M Mode Figure 4-11 M Mode Screen Picture Example Chapter 4 Functional Checks 4-13 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-7-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL M Mode OP Panel Controls Table 4-4 M Mode OP Panel Controls Step 1 4-14 Task Expected Result(s) Press M Mode key M Mode Starts 2 Adjust Gain Controls the amount of echo information displayed in an image. Turn B Mode dial to the left/right to increase/decrease Gain. Gain displays on the monitor in G (dB). 3 Display M-Mode Cursor Displays the M-Mode cursor on the B-Mode image. Press Cursor and Trackball to position M-Mode Cursor. Section 4-3 - General Procedure GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-7-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL M Mode Softmenu Key Table 4-5 M Mode Softmenu Key Step Task Expected Result(s) 1 Adjust Rejection Selects a level below which echoes will not be amplified (an echo must have a certain minimum amplitude before it will be processed). 2 Adjust Sweep Speed Changes the speed at which the time line is swept. The following speed values are available, 1, 2, 3, 4, 6, 8, 12, 16. 3 Adjust Edge Enhance Edge Enhance brings out subtle tissue differences and boundaries by enhancing the gray scale differences corresponding to the edges of structures. Adjustments to M Mode's edge enhancement affects the M Mode only. 4 Activate Gray Map Determines how the echo intensity levels received are presented as shades of gray. 6 Activate Colorize Enables gray scale image colorization. To deactivate, reselect a Gray Map. 7 Activate Full Timeline Displays only timeline screen. Press the Full Timescreen to activate. 8 Select Display Format Select the format to display B image and M image on the LCD. Press Display Format, and select from the pop up menu. Adjust Dynamic Range Dynamic Range controls how echo intensities are converted to shades of gray, thereby increasing the adjustable range of contrast. Power output Optimizes image quality and allows user to reduce beam intensity. 2% increments between 0-100%. Values greater than 0.1 are displayed. 9 10 Chapter 4 Functional Checks 4-15 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-8 4-3-8-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Color Flow Mode Checks Preparations 1.) Connect one of the probes listed in 3-6-6 "Available Probes" on page 3-26, in Chapter 3 Installation to the System probe connector. 2.) Turn ON the scanner (if it isn’t turned on already). Primary Menu Secondary Menu Frequency Spatial Filter Angle Steer Packet Size PRF Map Threshold Invert Wall Filter Baseline Line Density Flash Suppression Transparency Map Focus Position Frame Average Power Output Gain CF Mode Figure 4-12 Controls available in Color Flow Mode Figure 4-13 CFM Mode Screen Picture Example 4-16 Section 4-3 - General Procedure GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-8-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Color Flow Mode OP Panel Controls Table 4-5 Color Flow Mode OP Panel Controls Step 1 2 Task Expected Result(s) Press CFM-Mode key CFM Mode Starts Adjust Gain Amplifies the overall strength of the echoes processed in the Color Flow window. Turn the Gain dial (CFM Mode key) to the left/right to increase/decrease Gain. Chapter 4 Functional Checks 4-17 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-8-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Color Flow Mode Softemenu Key Table 4-6 Color Flow Mode Softmenu Key Step Expected Result(s) 1 Threshold Threshold assigns the gray scale level at which color information stops. 2 Packet Size Controls the number of samples gathered for a single color flow vector. 3 Select Color maps Allows a specific color map to be selected. After a selection has been made, the color bar displays the resultant map. 4 Adjust Frequency Enables the adjustment of the probe’s operating frequency. Press Frequency and select desired value. The selected frequency is displayed in the status window. 5 Set Frame Average Averages color frames. Press Frame Average up/down to smooth temporal averaging. 6 Color Invert Views blood flow from a different perspective. Press Invert to reverse the color map. 7 Adjust LIne Density Trades frame rate for sensitivity and spatial resolution. If the frame rate is too slow, reduce the size of the region of interest, select a different line density setting, or reduce the packet size. 8 Activate Spatial Filter 9 Adjust Dynamic Range Dynamic Range controls how echo intensities are converted to shades of gray, thereby increasing the adjustable range of contrast. 10 Activate ACE Eliminates the motion artifacts. Press Ace to activate. 11 Adjust Angle Steer Slants the Color Flow region of interest or the Doppler line to obtain a better Doppler angle. 12 Move Baseline Adjusts the baseline to accommodate faster or slower blood flows to eliminate aliasing. 13 14 4-18 Task Change PRF (Pulse Repetition Frequency) Velocity scale determines pulse repetition frequency. If the sample volume gate range exceeds single gate PRF capability, the system automatically switches to high PRF mode. Multiple gates appear, and HPRF is indicated on the display. Transparency Map Allows to select specific transparency map 15 Focus Position Increases the number of transmit focal zones or moves the focal zone(s) so that you can tighten up the beam for a specific area. A graphic caret corresponding to the focal zone position(s) appears on the right edge of the image. 16 Capture (Not available for LOGIQ P3 BT10) Section 4-3 - General Procedure GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Table 4-6 Color Flow Mode Softmenu Key Step Task Expected Result(s) 17 Power output Optimizes image quality and allows user to reduce beam intensity. 10% increments between 0-100%. Values greater than 0.1 are displayed. 18 Wall Filter Wall Filter insulates the Doppler signal from excessive noise caused from vessel movement. Chapter 4 Functional Checks 4-19 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-9 4-3-9-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Doppler Mode Checks Preparations 1.) Connect one of the probes listed in 3-6-6 "Available Probes" on page 3-26, in Chapter 3 Installation to the System probe connector. 2.) Turn ON the scanner (if it isn’t turned on already). Secondary Menu Primary Menu Frequency Baseline Quick Angle Sweep Speed PRF SV Length Angle Steer Angle Correct Spectral Invert Wall Filter Rejection Dynamic Range Display Format Full Timeline Trace Method Trace Sensitivity Trace direction Modify, Auto Calcs PW/CF Ratio Duplex Time Resolution Colorize Gray Map Power Output Auto Calcs Spectral Average Cycles, to Average PW Mode Gain B Pause M/D Cursor B Pause Figure 4-14 Controls available in Doppler Mode Figure 4-15 Doppler Mode Screen Picture Example 4-20 Section 4-3 - General Procedure GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-9-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Doppler Mode OP Panel Controls Table 4-7 Doppler Mode OP Panel Controls Step 1 2 3 4 Task Expected Result(s) Press PW Mode key PW Mode Starts Adjust Gain Amplifies the overall strength of the echoes processed in the Color Flow window. Turn the Gain dial (PW Mode key) to the left/right to increase/decrease Gain. Display M/D-Mode Cursor Displays the M/D-Mode cursor on the B-Mode image. Press Cursor and Trackball to position sample volume graphic. Click SV gate to adjust sample volume gate size. B-Pause Toggle between simultaneous and update presentation while viewing Spectral Doppler. Press B Pause to toggle between simultaneous and update. Chapter 4 Functional Checks 4-21 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-9-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Doppler Mode OP Panel Controls Table 4-8 Doppler Mode Touch Panel Controls Step Expected Result(s) 1 Adjust Rejection Selects a level below which echoes will not be amplified (an echo must have a certain minimum amplitude before it will be processed). 2 Adjust Sweep Speed Changes the speed at which timeline is swept. Press Sweep Speed up/down to increase/decrease the value. 3 Activate Full Timeline Displays only timeline screen. Press the Full Timescreen to activate. 4 Select Display Format Display layout can be preset to have B-Mode and Time-motion side-by-side or over-under. 5 Adjust Frequency Enables the adjustment of the probe’s operating frequency. Press Frequency and select desired value. The selected frequency is displayed in the status window. 6 Trace Direction Allows to select different trace direction. 7 Invert Vertically inverts the spectral trace without affecting the baseline position. Press invert to invert the spectral trace. The Plus and Minus signs on the velocity scale reverse when the spectrum is inverted. 8 Auto Calculation Enables or disables auto calculation. 9 Modify Calcs Activates the window to modify the auto calculation items. 10 Trace Method Allows to select different trace method. Activate Colorize Colorize the gray scale image to enhance the eyes’ discrimination capability. Press the Cololize, Trackball to cycle through available maps and press Set to select. 12 Activate Gray Map Displays a map window adjacent to the image. Move the trackball to select the map. The image reflects the map as scrolled through the selections. Press Set to select. 13 Dynamic Range Controls how echo intensities are converted to shades of gray. Click Dynamic Range to increase/decrease the value. Adjust Angle Correct Estimates the flow velocity in a direction at an angle to the Doppler vector by computing the angle between the Doppler vector and the flow to be measured. 15 Adjust Angle Steer Slant the Color Flow linear image left or right to get more information without moving probes. Click Angle Steer to the left to slant the linear image. 16 Move Baseline Adjusts the baseline to accommodate faster or slower blood flows to eliminate aliasing. 11 14 4-22 Task Section 4-3 - General Procedure GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Table 4-8 Doppler Mode Touch Panel Controls Step Task Expected Result(s) 17 Velocity scale determines pulse repetition frequency. If the sample volume gate range Change PRF (Pulse Repetition Frequencies) exceeds single gate PRF capability, the - (Wall Filter) system automatically switches to high PRF mode. Multiple gates appear, and HPRF is indicated on the display. 18 Trace Sensitivity Adjusts the sensitivity to get more accurate envelope trace. 19 Time Resolution Adjusts the resolution in frequency domain. 20 Spectral Average Optimizes the smoothness of the spectrum. Different levels can be selected. 21 Power output Optimizes image quality and allows user to reduce beam intensity. 10% increments between 0-100%. Values greater than 0.1 are displayed. 22 SV Length Sizes the sample volume gate. 23 Wall Filter Wall Filter insulates the Doppler signal from excessive noise caused from vessel movement. Chapter 4 Functional Checks 4-23 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-10 NOTE: 4-3-10-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Basic Measurements The following instructions assume that you first scan the patient and then press Freeze. Distance and Tissue Depth Measurements 1.) Press MEASURE once; an active caliper displays. 2.) To position the active caliper at the start point (distance) or the most anterior point (tissue depth), move the TRACKBALL. 3.) To fix the start point, press Set. The system fixes the first caliper and displays a second active caliper. 4.) To position the second active caliper at the end point (distance) or the most posterior point (tissue depth), move the TRACKBALL. 5.) To complete the measurement, press SET. The system displays the distance or tissue depth value in the measurement results window. Before you complete a measurement: To toggle between active calipers, press MEASURE. To erase the second caliper and the current data measured and start the measurement again, press CLEAR once. NOTE: To rotate through and activate previously fixed calipers, adjust CURSOR SELECT. NOTE: After you complete the measurement, to erase all data that has been measured to this point, but not data entered onto worksheets, press CLEAR. 4-3-10-2 Circumference/Area (Ellipse) Measurement 1.) Press MEASURE once; an active caliper displays. 2.) To position the active caliper, move the TRACKBALL. 3.) To fix the start point, press SET. The system fixes the first caliper and displays a second active caliper. 4.) To position the second caliper, move the TRACKBALL. 5.) Adjust the ELLIPSE; an ellipse with an initial circle shape appears. 6.) To position the ellipse and to size the measured axes (move the calipers), move the TRACKBALL. 7.) To increase the size, rotate the ELLIPSE button clockwise. To decrease the size, contrarotate the ELLIPSE button. 8.) To toggle between active calipers, press MEASURE. 9.) To complete the measurement, press SET. The system displays the circumference and area in the measurement results window. Before you complete a measurement: 4-3-10-3 - To erase the ellipse and the current data measured, press CLEAR once. The original caliper is displayed to restart the measurement. - To exit the measurement function without completing the measurement, press CLEAR a second time. Worksheets Measurement/Calculation worksheets are available to display and edit measurements and calculations. There are generic worksheets as well as Application specific worksheets. The worksheets are selected from the Measurement Touch Panel. 4-24 Section 4-3 - General Procedure GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-11 4-3-11-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Probe/Connectors Usage Connecting a probe 1.) Place the probe's carrying case on a stable surface and open the case. 2.) Carefully remove the probe and unwrap the probe cable. 3.) DO NOT allow the probe head to hang free. Impact to the probe head could result in irreparable damage. 4.) Align the connector with the probe port and carefully push into place. 5.) Lock the probe latch upward. 6.) Carefully position the probe cord so it is free to move and is not resting on the floor. 4-3-11-2 Activating the probe The probe activates in the currently-selected operating mode. The probe's default settings for the mode and selected exam are used automatically. 4-3-11-3 Deactivating the probe When deactivating the probe, the probe is automatically placed in standby mode. 1.) Press the Freeze key. 2.) Gently wipe the excess gel from the face of the probe. (Refer to the Basic User Manual for complete probe cleaning instructions.) 3.) Carefully slide the probe into the Front Probe Port and rotate the probe lock clock wise . Ensure that the probe is placed gently in the probe holder. 4-3-11-4 Disconnecting the probe Probes can be disconnected at any time. However, the probe should not be selected as the active probe. 1.) Rotate the probe lock antclock wise. 2.) Pull the probe straight out of the probe port. 3.) Carefully slide the probe and away from the probe port. 4.) Ensure the cable is free. 5.) Be sure that the probe head is clean before placing the probe in its storage box. 4-3-12 4-3-12-1 Using Cine Activating CINE Press Freeze, then roll the Trackball to activate CINE. To start CINE Loop playback, press Run/Stop. To stop CINE Loop playback. press Run/Stop. 4-3-12-2 Quickly Move to Start/End Frame Press First to move to the first CINE frame; press Last to move to the last CINE frame. 4-3-12-3 Start Frame/End Frame Press the Start Frame Two-Button Softkey to move to the beginning of the CINE Loop. Adjust the Start Frame up/down Two-Button Softkey upward to move forward through the CINE Loop. Adjust the Softkey downward to move backward through the CINE Loop. Press the End Frame Two-Button Softkey to move to the end of the CINE Loop. Adjust the End Frame up/down Two-Button Softkey upward to move forward through the CINE Loop. Adjust the Softkey downward to move backward through the CINE Loop. Chapter 4 Functional Checks 4-25 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-12-4 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Adjusting the CINE Loop Playback Speed Adjust the Loop Speed up/down Two-Button Softkey to increase/decrease the CINE Loop playback speed. 4-3-12-5 Moving through a CINE Loop Frame By Frame Adjust the Frame by Frame up/down Two-Button Softkey to move through CINE memory one frame at a time. 4-3-13 Image Management (QG) For Image Management functionality refer to the LOGIQ P3 Quick Guide. It talks about several topics: 4-26 • Clipboard • Printing Images • Browsing and Managing an Exam’s Stored Image • Connectivity, and Dataflow Concept and Creation • Starting an Exam • Configuring Connectivity • TCP/IP • Services (Destinations) • Buttons • Views • Verifying and Pinging a Device Section 4-3 - General Procedure GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-14 NOTE: 4-3-14-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Backup and Restore Database, Preset Configurations and Images Please scan the devices (USB, Pen Drive, HDD etc..) for virus before using it with the system. Formatting Media 1.) To format the backup media, DVD-drive, select the UTILITY button on the Keyboard. 2.) Select CONNECTIVITY, then REMOVABLE MEDIA. Properly label and Insert the backup media. 3.) Select the media type from the drop down menu. 4.) Enter the label for the media as shown in . It is best to use all capital letters with no spaces or punctuation marks. Press Format. Figure 4-16 Format and Verify Media 5.) The Ultrasound system displays a pop-up menu, as shown in . When the formatting has been completed, press OK to continue. 6.) If desired, verify that the format was successful by returning to Utility->Connectivity->Tools and selecting VERIFY as shown in . Figure 4-17 Format Successful Pop-up Menu Chapter 4 Functional Checks 4-27 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-14-2 NOTE: PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Backup System Presets and Configurations Always backup any preset configurations before a software reload. This ensures that if the presets need to be reloaded, after the software update, they will be the same ones the customer was using prior to service. 1.) Insert a formatted DVD-R into the drive. 2.) On the Keyboard, press UTILITY. 3.) On the LCD display, press SYSTEM. 4.) On the LCD display, select BACKUP/RESTORE. NOTE: If you are not logged in as GE Service or with administrator privileges, the Operator Login window is displayed. Log on with administrator privileges. 5.) In the Backup list, select Patient Archive, Report Archive and User Defined Configuration. 6.) In the Media field, select DVD Drive(or USB memory device). 7.) Select BACKUP. The system performs the backup. As it proceeds, status information is displayed on the Backup/Restore screen. Check here to backup presets and configurations Figure 4-18 Backup/Restore Menu 4-28 Section 4-3 - General Procedure GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-14-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Restore System Presets and Configurations CAUTION The restore procedure overwrites the existing database on the local hard drive. Make sure to insert the correct DVD (or USB memory device). 1.) Insert the Backup/Restore DVD (or USB memory device) into the drive. 2.) On the Keyboard, press UTILITY. 3.) On the LCD display, press SYSTEM. 4.) On the LCD display, select BACKUP/RESTORE. NOTE: If you are not logged in with administrator privileges, the Operator Login window is displayed. Log on with administrator privileges. 5.) In the Restore list, select Patient Archive, Report Archive and User Defined Configuration. 6.) In the Media field, select the Backup/Restore DVD (or USB memory device). 7.) Select RESTORE. The system performs the restore. As it proceeds, status information is displayed on the Backup/Restore screen. Check here to restore presets and configurations. Figure 4-19 Backup/Restore Menu Chapter 4 Functional Checks 4-29 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-14-4 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Archiving Images 1.) Insert the archive media. To format the archive media, DVD-R, select the Utility button on the Keyboard. 2.) Select Connectivity, then Tools. 3.) Format the DVD-R. Verify the format if desired. 4.) Images will be moved from the hard drive by date. Therefore, the best way is to label media by date. NOTE: Images will be moved from the hard drive by date. Therefore, the best way to label media is by date. When images are moved to the archive media, they will be deleted from the system hard drive. However, the patient database (backed up earlier) maintains pointers to the location of the images on the archive media. Figure 4-20 Format DVD-RW Screen 5.) Select Backup/Restore, then EZBackup/Move. 6.) Select “Backup File Older Than in Days”. Select the days/exam to be backed up Figure 4-21 EZBackup/Move 4-30 Section 4-3 - General Procedure GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-14-4 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Archiving Images (cont’d) 7.) Press PATIENT and set the Dataflow to store images directly to DVD-R. 8.) From the image screen, press EZBACKUP/MOVE. The Move Images pop-up appears. Figure 4-22 Image Archive Move Pop-up Menu 9.) Press Next on pop-up message. 10.)A media check message appears. Press OK to continue. Figure 4-23 Media check message Chapter 4 Functional Checks 4-31 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-14-4 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Archiving Images (cont’d) 11.)Press Finish after Backup/Move complete. Figure 4-24 EZBackup/Move complete All databases, presets and images should now be saved to removable media. 4-3-14-5 Full Backup 1.) Connect the USB HDD to system. 2.) Select Backup/Restore, then Emergency Repair Disk. 3.) Select “Reminder Dialog Interval Days”. Reminder Dialog Interval Days Figure 4-25 Emergency Repair Disk 4-32 Section 4-3 - General Procedure GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-14-5 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Full Backup (cont’d) 4.) Return to scan mode. Press Ctrl + B, the Emergency Disk Making window pop-up appears. Figure 4-26 Emergency Disk Making Pop-up Menu 5.) Press Next on pop-up message. 6.) A storage information message appears. Press Next to continue. Figure 4-27 Storage Information message Chapter 4 Functional Checks 4-33 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-14-5 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Full Backup (cont’d) 7.) Press Finish after Emergency Disk Making complete. Figure 4-28 Emergency Disk Making Complete All databases, presets and images should now be saved to Emergency Disk. 8.) Press Ctrl + R, Emergency Disk Recovery window pop-up appear. Figure 4-29 Emergency Disk Recovery 9.) Press Next on pop-up message. 4-34 Section 4-3 - General Procedure GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-14-5 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Full Backup (cont’d) 10.)A recovery information message appears. Press Next to continue. Figure 4-30 Recovery Information message 11.)Press Finish after Emergency Disk Recovery complete. Figure 4-31 Emergency Disk Recovery Complete Chapter 4 Functional Checks 4-35 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 4-3-15 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Patient Healthcare Information Patient Healthcare Information (PHI) is the patient data stored in the USB pendrive/USB HDD inserted in the LOGIQ P3. Ensure that the PHI is erased from the USB pendrive/USB HDD, or the SATA HDD is removed from the LOGIQ P3 system before shipping (repairs/replacement). In case, if any patient information still resides on the LOGIQ P3, GE contacts the customer to immediately collect the data. However, GE keeps the patient information in a secured environment for a period of one month. The data is deleted permanently after one month. It is strictly prohibited to sent the PHI outside the confidential patient-doctor environment without encrypting the data. If PHI is sent to GE employees for troubleshooting, the PHI must be encrypted or protected from unauthorized access and the files must be compressed using PKZIP with a password. The PHI must be sent to GE employees only through the GE intranet. For LOGIQ P3, the GE intranet address is: http://libraries.ge.com/foldersIndex.do?entity_id=12065698101&sid=101&sf=1 NOTE: 4-36 Do not email the data which includes PHI. Section 4-3 - General Procedure GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 4-4 Software Configuration Checks Table 4-9 Software Configuration Checks Step Task to do Expected Result(s) 1. Check Date and Time setting Date and Time are correct 2. Check that Location (Hospital Name) is correct Location Name is correct 3. Check Language settings Desired Language is displayed Check assignment of Printer Keys The default function for Print1-3 Keys is P1 (store image); P2 (print); P3 (USB Quick Save). Print1-3 Keys can also be assigned as desired by the customer 4. 5. Check that all of the customer’s options are set up correct All authorized functions are enabled Section 4-5 Peripheral Checks Check that peripherals work as described below: Table 4-10 Peripheral Checks Step Task to do Expected Result(s) 1. Press (FREEZE) Stop image acquisition. 2. Press (P2) on the Control Panel The image displayed on the screen is printed on B&W printer. 3. Connect with Foot Switch on USB port and press once. To start image acquisition (the same function as (FREEZE) key). Chapter 4 Functional Checks 4-37 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 4-6PC based products - Vulnerability and Precautions Most GE Ultrasound (GE U/S) products are PC based, which means they are potentially vulnerable to infection by viruses aimed at PCs. The three ways that viruses spread and how GE U/S products are affected: Internet - GE U/S products in general do not contain, or do not use the functionality (typically email applications and web browsers) that is used for spreading viruses (or trojan horses) in this way. The only internet connection available from a GE U/S product is to the GE online center, which is done through a secure VPN connection. Therefore, there is very little risk that GE U/S products will be infected by internet-spread viruses or trojan horses. Network-worms - All GE U/S products can be networked and are potentially vulnerable to infection. GE U/S has taken and will continue to take precautions to limit this vulnerability. Removable Disks - GE U/S products support the use of removable disks. But these GE products will actively use the following kinds of disks only: • GE software installation disks • Image disks (in DICOM or GE proprietary format) • GE backup disks The latter two kinds of disks do not contain files that could contain viruses (executable files or documents that might contain macros). GE U/S takes precautions to make the software installation disks virus free. Auto execution of files on removable disks is disabled by GE U/S products. Although new computer viruses continue to evolve rapidly in a manner that is difficult or impossible to predict with certainty, there is very little risk that GE U/S products will be infected by viruses from removable disks. 4-38 Section 4-6 - PC based products - Vulnerability and Precautions GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Chapter 5 Components and Functions (Theory) Section 5-1 Overview This chapter explains LOGIQ P3’s system concepts, component arrangement, and subsystem function. It also describes the Power Distribution System (PDS) and probes. Table 5-1 Contents in Chapter 5 Section 5-1 Description Page Number Overview 5-1 Block Diagram - Logiq P3 5-2 5-2 PWA Assy Diagrams 5-11 5-3 Power Diagrams 5-22 5-4 Common Service Platform 5-24 5-5 RFS (Request for Service) 5-26 5-6 Machine RFS 5-28 5-1-1 Chapter 5 Components and Functions (Theory) 5-1 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 5-1-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Block Diagram - Logiq P3 Figure 5-1 Logiq P3 System Block Diagram 5-2 Section 5-1 - Overview GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 5-1-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Block Diagram - LOGIQ P3 BT10 Figure 5-2 LOGIQ P3 BT10 System Block Diagram Chapter 5 Components and Functions (Theory) 5-3 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 5-1-3 5-4 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL General Information • LOGIQ P3 is an ultrasound imaging scanner. • The system can be used for: - 2D Black and White imaging - 2D Color Flow - M-Mode Black and White imaging - Doppler - A number of combinations of the above • LOGIQ P3 is a digital beam forming system that can handle up to 192 elements linear probes. • Signal flow from the Probe Connector Panel to the Front End, to the Mid Processors and (TMST) and finally to the LCD and peripherals. • System configuration is stored on a hard disk and all necessary software is loaded from the hard disk on power up. Section 5-1 - Overview GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 5-1-4 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Front End TX64 Pulser x64 TMST TX CTRL FPGA TPG2 x4 USC Bus LV power FPGA Local Bus 32bits Probe Connector SH4 w/PC I USC SRAM SDRAM (32MB ) FPC 128 PCI 64 HV MUX LV,HV power CHA COM DSP FIFO EMIFB 16bits SD RAM RX64 T/R x64 EMIFA 64bits SDRAM (32MB ) RX CTRL FPGA CWD ADC x2 SRAM 10x64 VCA8616 x8 ADS5121 x8 OQX2 x4 Delay Line Gain Mixer BPF CW x20 Figure 5-3 The Front End The front end generates the strong transmit bursts, transmitted by the probes as ultrasound into the body. It also receives weak ultrasound echoes from blood cells and body structure, amplifies the signals and converts them to a 10bit digital signal. The digital representation of the signal is presented to the mid processor section. • PAM(PreAmplifier): The preamplifier amplifies 64 echo signals. The reception signals are sent to ADC on RX64. • RX64 (LOGIQ P3 Front Processor): Convert the analog echo signal to digital. • TX64 (LOGIQ P3 Transmission Board):This has 64 channel bipolar drivers. Chapter 5 Components and Functions (Theory) 5-5 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 5-1-5 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL The Back End HDD Data from Front End FPGA/DSP AGP Graphic SVGA LCD PCI Bus To CPU Power Supply Figure 5-4 The Back End The TMST grabs the data from the Image Port, stores it in a memory, performs scan conversion to pixel domain and drives the system LCD display. 5-1-6 Top Console The Top Console includes a Standby/On switch, a keyboard, different controls for manipulating the picture quality, controls for use in Measure & Analyze (M&A), and loudspeakers for stereo sound output (used during Doppler scanning). 5-6 Section 5-1 - Overview GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Speakers On/Off Switch Keyboard Figure 5-5 Top Console Chapter 5 Components and Functions (Theory) 5-7 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 5-1-7 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL External I/O Figure 5-6 External I/O module overview External I/O: The external I/O is the interface between the scanner and all external items. Examples:Network, USB interface medical grade printer and external medical grade SVGA displayer. 5-1-8 Peripherals DVR, Color printer, Footswitch, VGA monitor, TV and a Black & White Printer and Bluetooth printer can be connected to the external I/O. 5-8 Section 5-1 - Overview GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 5-1-9 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Wiring Figure 5-7 Wiring Diagram (LOGIQ P3) • TX64: LOGIQ P3 Transmit board • RX64: LOGIQ P3 Front end processing board • MST: LOGIQ P3 Master board • PWR SW: Power Switch • FPC: Flexible Print Circuit board • PDB: Power Distribution Board • SSR: Solid State Relay Chapter 5 Components and Functions (Theory) 5-9 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 5-1-9-1 5-1-9-1-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Power Up sequence description Overview The Power Up sequence can be divided into the following steps: 1.) Switch ON the mains on the Power entry module. 2.) +5V standby is provided to SOM/MST. 3.) MST detects contact of the Power ON button and provides input to SOM and the power supply unit, which will power ON enabling the 12V and 5V to the entire system. 5-1-9-2 5-1-9-2-1 Power Down sequence description Overview There are two ways to switch off the system: 1.) Select shutdown from the Application. 2.) Keep the Keyboard ON/OFF button pressed for more than 4 seconds. Keyboard power button NO Shutdown message If pressed ON for < 4 secs YES PS ON = LOW MST/SOM PS ON = HIGH PS ON = LOW PDB BOARD Power Supply +12V, +5V = ON Buffer Power Supply Off System Voltage = ON Blue color indicates Power On sequence Red color indicates Power Off sequence Figure 5-8 On/Off Sequence 5-10 Section 5-1 - Overview GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 5-2PWA Assy Diagrams 5-2-1 TMST To FPGA To Power Block Figure 5-9 TMST Block Diagram Chapter 5 Components and Functions (Theory) 5-11 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 5-2-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL TMST (cont’d) TUSC FPGA Cont Power Block TMST Block Diagram (cont’d) 5-12 Section 5-2 - PWA Assy Diagrams GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 5-2-1 5-2-1-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL TMST (cont’d) • SH4: Front controlling CPU • PWR_DIAG: Power diagnostic circuit • ETX: Card CPU unit Description This diagram describes the TMST board. It controls the front end of LOGIQ P3 and also communicate with PC system through PCI interface. The main function: • Generate clock signal and distributing each clock signal. • Generate DUSC bus cycle. • Power diagnostics: HV, LV. • Transmit image raw data (B/CFM/DOP) to PC after assembling packet including header information. Chapter 5 Components and Functions (Theory) 5-13 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 5-2-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL RX64 Figure 5-10 RX64 Block Diagram 5-2-2-1 • RX64: LOGIQ P3 Front End Processor board • ADC: Analog/Digital converter • OQX2: Beamform ASIC • CHACOM: B/M/CFM/Dop signal processor ASIC • FPIC FPGA: Front Process interface control Description This diagram describes the RX64 (Front Process) board. It resides below TX board (located at the bottom layer). The main function: 5-14 • Convertor 64 channels echo which is from preamp to digital signal. • Focus the received RF signals by digital beamforming technology. • Control CHACOM to acquire optimum image data. Section 5-2 - PWA Assy Diagrams GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 5-2-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL TX64 Figure 5-11 TX64 Block Diagram 5-2-3-1 • TX64: LOGIQ P3 Transmit board • TPG2: Transmit Pulse Generator • TMST: LOGIQ P3 Master board • TXMX FPGA: Transmit and MUX controlling FPGA Description This diagram describes LOGIQ P3 TX64 board. The main function: • Generate the transmit pulse. • Drive the Tx pulse with high voltage. Chapter 5 Components and Functions (Theory) 5-15 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 5-2-4 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL CWD Figure 5-12 CWD Block Diagram 5-2-4-1 • CWD: Continue wave doppler board • DEM: Demodulator • HPF: High pass filter • LPF: Low pass filter Description This diagram describes LOGIQ P3 CWD board, it resides under RX64 board. The main function: • 5-16 Generate continue wave form image data. Section 5-2 - PWA Assy Diagrams GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 5-2-5 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Connector Board Figure 5-13 Connector Board Block Diagram • There are 3 banks of relays on the Connector Board one each for each probe connector. • There is one FPGA that acts like a buffer for the Probe related signals and is the interface between the probe and the main TX Board FPGA. There is a I2C slave also implemented on this FPGA that responds and interfaces with the Host I2C controller on the TX board it is mainly for probe selection and control • The Power supply to the TX board from the PDB board is connected via the Connector Board. Chapter 5 Components and Functions (Theory) 5-17 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 5-2-6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Rear Panel-1 & Rear panel 2 Figure 5-14 Rear Panel 1 & 2 (LOGIQ P3) 5-18 • Rear panel provides all the external interfaces to the user like 1 ethernet port, 1 VGA port, 4 USB ports, BNC Connector and one S-Video connector. • The Ethernet signals and VGA signals are directly routed from the MST board via the FRC cable with buffering. For the Video out signals (BNC and S-Video) there is a video conversion logic built which converts the VGA input into the S video and Composite video formats. • The resolution of the Video output would be 640x480. • Power supply to the rear panel is connected from the PDB board. Section 5-2 - PWA Assy Diagrams GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Standard VGA output Resolution 640x480 Figure 5-15 Rear Panel 1 & 2 (LOGIQ P3 BT10) Chapter 5 Components and Functions (Theory) 5-19 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 5-2-7 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Keyboard Figure 5-16 Keyboard Block Diagram Keyboard has the following main interfaces: 1.) USB controller that interfaces the Keyboard to the System SW. The ultrasound Keys are directly mapped to this controller. 2.) Trackball and Alphanumeric Keyboard is connected to the system via the PS2 interface. There is one Microcontroller that decodes the Alphanumeric key press information and relays this information to the system via the PS2. 3.) One USB port is extended from the MST board and is available on the Keyboard. 5-20 Section 5-2 - PWA Assy Diagrams GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 5-2-7-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Indicator LEDs Table 5-2 LED Indications Function Module LED Location LED Color LED Function Control panel Power switch Amber When StandBy, Turns Green when switched ON. Main Power activity RX64 DS1 Green (Normal Condition) FPGA Config TX64 DS1 Green (Normal Condition) FPGA Config Green (Normal Condition) PDB +5v Green (Normal Condition) +12v Green (Normal Condition) +5v_ Stand by Probe 1 Connected Green (Normal Condition) Connector Board D5 D6 Green (Normal Condition) Probe 2 Connected D7 Green (Normal Condition) Probe 3 Connected Chapter 5 Components and Functions (Theory) 5-21 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 5-3 Power Diagrams 5-3-1 Overview The AC Power assy’s main tasks are to isolate and output to the AC/DC unit which is inside the system console. The input of AC power pack will be the AC outlet, the range is AC 100v Min & 240v Max configuration support is available in power pack. Figure 5-17 AC Power Distribution Block Diagram (LOGIQ P3) 5-22 Section 5-3 - Power Diagrams GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Figure 5-18 AC Power Distribution Block Diagram (LOGIQ P3BT10) The mains cord has plugs in one side end (On Wall). A male plug (of Power Cord) connects to the mains outlet on site. From the Main Circuit Breaker, the AC power is routed via an Inrush Current Limiter to a internal outlet connector for the Main power supply. The power ON OFF is actually controlled by the MST PWA. This signal is routed from the Keyboard ON OFF button to the MST board and then to the PDB board. The MST board has logic that controls the state of this signal. The output from this logic is connected to the PDB board that either switches on or switches off the Power supply. Chapter 5 Components and Functions (Theory) 5-23 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 5-4 Common Service Platform 5-4-1 Introduction The Service Platform contains a set of software modules that are common to all PC backend ultrasound and cardiology systems. The Common Service Platform will increase service productivity and reduce training and service costs. 5-4-2 5-4-2-1 Global Service User Interface (GSUI) Internationalization The user interface provided by the service platform is designed for GE personnel and as such is in English only. There is no multi-lingual capability built into the Service Interface. 5-4-2-2 Service Login Select Utility->Service. This button links the user or the Field Engineer (FE) to the service login screen. Figure 5-19 Service Login Screen 5-4-2-3 Access / Security The service interface has different access and security user levels. Each user is only granted access to the tools that are authorized for their use. NOTE: 5-24 A Service Dongle is necessary for use by GE Service when performing proprietary level diagnostics. OnLine Center access to the scanner requires the password and they must have ‘Disruptive’ permission and customer input to run diagnostics. Section 5-4 - Common Service Platform GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 5-4-2-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Access / Security (cont’d) Table 5-3 Service Login User Levels User Level Access Authorization Operator uls Administrator Authorized access to specified diagnostics, error logs and utilities. Same acquisition diagnostic tests as GE Service. External Service GE Service NOTE: Password uls gogems Knowledge of a service level password. A physical Service Key (Dongle) required rotating security password For a GE Field Engineer, the password changes at specific intervals. Access with the password is tied to the service key. Every access request, whether successful or not, will be logged into a service access log that is viewable to authorized users. Figure 5-20 Customer Service Home Page 5-4-2-4 For a service call with no FRU replacement, use the following debrief Script: Refer the Service Manual, Chapter 4: Basic Functional Checks in the service manual. Equipment has passed all the required tests and is ready for use. Chapter 5 Components and Functions (Theory) 5-25 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 5-5RFS (Request for Service) 5-5-1 General This describes general RFS functionality. RFS function is a call for service to be used by customer or FE directly from the system instead of calling GE Cares. 5-5-2 Sending RFS Procedure Service Platform should be turned off in order to open RFS window. System must be connected to network, configured and checked out to be able to send the RFS. 1.) Right Click on “Connect to GE” icon. Figure 5-21 Contact GE icon All the fields that are marked with asterisk * are mandatory and should be filled in order to send the RFS request to On Line Center. 2.) Fill out the Last name, First name, and Phone number. Extension, Email, and Other system ID fields are optional. 3.) Select Problem Type. If Problem is about “No Boot”, “No Image”, “Error message”, “Lock up”, “Probe”, “Peripherals”, select “Service” for the Problem Type. If Problem is about “Presets”, “Reports”, “Measurements”, or “Probe not recognized”, select “Applications” for the Problem Type. 4.) Select the Problem Area. 5-26 Section 5-5 - RFS (Request for Service) GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 5.) Write the detailed problem description in the Problem Description field. Figure 5-22 RFS Window 6.) Then the “Send” button is enabled. Figure 5-22 RFS Window 7.) Verify that "Send" button is enabled. 8.) Click “Send” button and wait for confirmation window with reference number on the screen. 9.) Verify that "confirmation message" pops up in the screen. 10.)RFS request is completed. Chapter 5 Components and Functions (Theory) 5-27 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 11.)On Line Center will contact the customer shortly by phone. Section 5-6 Machine RFS This describes general MRFS (Machine RFS) functionality. MRFS function is an automatic call for service from the system to the OLC when system detects high temperature or high or low voltage. 5-6-1 Enabling MRFS NOTE: In order to enable MRFS, System must be connected to network and should be checked out to a product server. Default MRFS user should also be set. 1.) If a system is not already checked out, the system should be checked out to a product server. 2.) MRFS function is an automatic call for service from the system to the OLC when system detects high temperature or high or low voltage. 3.) Right Click on “Connect to GE” icon. Figure 5-23 Contact GE icon 4.) When the RFS window pops up, click on “Users” tab. Figure 5-24 Users tab 5.) Press “Add User”. 5-28 Section 5-6 - Machine RFS GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Figure 5-25 Add User All the fields that are marked with asterisk * are mandatory and should be filled. 6.) When fields with asterisk are filled, “Add User” button is enabled. Figure 5-26 Add User 7.) Pess “Add User” button. 8.) Check the checkbox next to the name to set to the default contact. Then Press “Set Default Machine Contact” button. Chapter 5 Components and Functions (Theory) 5-29 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Figure 5-27 Set Default Machine Contact 9.) Now the MRFS is enabled. 10.)When system detects high temperature or abnormal voltage, it will send the RFS to the OLC automatically. 5-30 Section 5-6 - Machine RFS GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Chapter 6 Service Adjustments Section 6-1 Overview 6-1-1 Purpose of this chapter 6 This section describes how to test and adjust the scanner. These tests are optional. You may use them to check the system for errors. Table 6-1 Contents in chapter Section Description Page Number 6-1 Overview 6-1 6-2 Monitor Adjustments 6-2 Chapter 6 Service Adjustments 6-1 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 6-2 Monitor Adjustments 6-2-1 Adjustments Procedures To adjust the brightness: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. NOTE: Contrast Indicator Brightness Indicator Dim Brightness Indicator Light Button Adjustment (-) Button Toggle Button Adjustment (+) Button Default Factory setting for Contrast & Bightness is 80 and Dim brightness 50 as shown in Fig A. Fig. A Fig. B Figure 6-1 LCD Monitor Dim brightness is the LCD lamp brightness control. 6-2-2 Monitor Calibration procedure. 1.Select Utility in A/N Keboard>Test patterns>Select the Brightness calibration and perform the monitor calibration procedure as displayed in the monitor as shown in Fig B. 6-2 Section 6-2 - Monitor Adjustments GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Chapter 7 Diagnostics/Troubleshooting Section 7-1 Overview 7-1-1 Purpose of Chapter 7 This section describes how to setup and run the tools and software that help maintain image quality and system operation. Very basic host, system and board level diagnostics are run whenever power is applied. Some Service Tools may be run at the application level. However most software tests are required. Table 7-1 Contents in Chapter 7 Section Description Page Number 7-1 Overview 7-1 7-2 Gathering Trouble Data 7-2 7-3 USB Quick Save 7-4 7-4 Screen Captures 7-6 7-5 Wire - LAN Network 7-9 7-6 Troubleshooting 7-10 Chapter 7 Diagnostics/Troubleshooting 7-1 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 7-2 Gathering Trouble Data 7-2-1 Overview There may be a time when it would be advantageous to capture trouble images and system data (logs) for acquisition to be sent back to the manufacturer for analysis. There are different options to acquire this data that would give different results. 7-2-2 Collect Vital System Information The following information is necessary in order to properly analyze data or images being reported as a malfunction or being returned to the manufacturer: - Product Name = LOGIQ P3 From the Utility>System>About screen: Applications Software - Software Version - Software Part Number System Image Software 7-2 - Image Revision - Image Part Number Section 7-2 - Gathering Trouble Data GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 7-2-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Collect a Trouble Image with Logs If the system should malfunction, press the Alt-D keys simultaneously. This will collect a screen capture of the image monitor, system presets and the following logs: NOTE: - Keyboard Shadow Log - Error Logs - Crash Log - Power Supply - Temperature Power Supply and Temperature logs are not currently being updated by the LOGIQ P3. This Alt-D function is available at all times. Figure 7-1 ALT+D Dialog Box When Alt-D is pressed, a menu box appears that allows for: - A place to enter a description of the problem - A choice to store to a pre-formatted DVD-R, RD (Removable Disk) or to the Export directory D: export. The subsequent file is compressed and time stamped. The screen capture is a bitmap which eliminates the possibility of artifacts from compression. Chapter 7 Diagnostics/Troubleshooting 7-3 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 7-3 USB Quick Save 7-3-1 Overview There may be times when the customer or field engineer will want to directly save images into USB memory. This is accomplished by saving individual Cine clips (moving images- avi format) or still images (jpg format) directly to a USB memory disk by pressing a Print Key. The P3 key is the factory default print key to accomplish the USB Quick Save. However, the default is for the Image Area only or the customer may have customized the P3 Key function. 7-3-2 Check and Record the P3 Key Function Check the function of the Print 3 Key in the event that the customer may have made some customized settings. 1.) Click Utility on the keyboard. 2.) Select Connectivity from the Utilities Menu. 3.) Select the Buttons tab on the Connectivity screen. 4.) In the Physical Print Buttons field, select Print3. The Connectivity/Buttons Screen will be displayed like the one shown in Figure 7-2 on page 7-4 . Figure 7-2 Buttons Set Up Screen P3 is the factory default USB Quick Save key. If it is not set to Image Area, proceed to step 5 to record the customer’s customized settings. 7-4 Section 7-3 - USB Quick Save GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 7-3-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Check and Record the P3 Key Function (cont’d) 5.) In the Destinations section, record the service that is displayed. 6.) In the Physical Print Buttons section, record the parameters related to the service. 7-3-3 Setting the P3 Key to USB Quick Save If the P3 Key is not set to USB Quick Save: 1.) While on the Connectivity screen, with the Buttons tab displayed, go to the Destinations list. 2.) From the list select USB Quick Save. Press [>>] to add the selection to the Printflow View section. 3.) Ensure that the Physical Print Buttons section for capture Area is set to Image Area and No Image Compression. 4.) The P3 Key should now be set up for USB Quick Save, sending the images directly to the USB memory. NOTICE It is unable to get full screen using USB Quick Save, just Image Area is available. Chapter 7 Diagnostics/Troubleshooting 7-5 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 7-4 Screen Captures There may be times when the customer or field engineer will want to capture a presentation on the screen. This is accomplished by first saving the image(s) to the clipboard using a Print Key. There’s no factory default print key to accomplish a secondary screen capture. However, customer may have customize any of Print Key function. Here, take Print3 button for example, Print1 and Print3 are the same. Therefore, screen capture should involve the following steps: 1.) Check and record any custom settings for the Print3 button. 2.) Set the Print3 button to Whole Screen, Secondary Capture. 3.) Capture the required screens to the Hard Drive or DVD-R. 4.) Restore the Print3 button to it’s original settings. 7-4-1 Check and Record the P3 Key Function Check the function of the Print3 Key in the event that the customer may have made some custom settings. 1.) Click Utility on the keyboard. 2.) Select Connectivity from the Utilities Menu. 3.) Select the Buttons tab on the Connectivity screen. 4.) In the Physical Print Buttons field, select Print3. The Connectivity/Buttons Screen will be displayed like the one shown in Figure 7-2 on page 7-4 . If P3 is not set to Whole Screen, as shown in Figure 7-2, proceed to step 5 to record the customer’s customized settings. 5.) In the Destinations section, record the service that is displayed. 6.) In the Physical Print Buttons section, record the parameters related to the service. 7-4-2 Setting the P3 Key to Screen Capture If the P3 Key is not set to screen capture: 1.) While on the Connect screen, with the Buttons tab displayed, go to the Destinations list. 2.) From the list select Copy To Dataflow. Press [>>] to add the selection to the Printflow View section. 3.) Ensure that the Physical Print Buttons section for capture Area is set to Whole Screen, secondary Capture and No Image Compression. 4.) The P3 Key should now be set up for whole screen capture, sending the screens to the image buffer (clipboard). 7-4-3 Capturing a Screen The following is a generic process to capture any screen from the scanner: 1.) Navigate to and display the image/screen to be captured. 2.) Press P3. This will place a snapshot of the screen on the “clipboard” displayed at the bottom of the scan image display. 7-6 Section 7-4 - Screen Captures GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 7-4-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Capturing a Screen (cont’d) Clipboard Thumbnails Menu Figure 7-3 Select Image to Capture 3.) Click FREEZE to unfreeze the image to view the image screen and the snapshots displayed on the bottom. 4.) Highlight the snapshot to be stored to RD (Removable Disk) or DVD-R. 5.) Select Menu on the right side of the image screen, then highlight and select SAVE AS. Save As Figure 7-4 Menu > Save As Chapter 7 Diagnostics/Troubleshooting 7-7 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 7-4-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Capturing a Screen (cont’d) Figure 7-5 Save Dialog Box 6.) A Save dialog box will be opened. Choose d:\export folder as the archive location to save the image on the hard disk or DVD-R. NOTICE After capture the snapshot of the screen to the “clipboard” and save it to the hard disk or other media, it is not full screen image on the hard disk or media. 7-4-4 Reset the P3 Key to Customer’s Functionality If the customer had programmed the P3 Key to a function other than screen capture, restore that functionality recorded in section 7-4-1 on page 7-6. Refer to Figure 7-2. 1.) Click Utility on the keyboard. 2.) Select Connectivity from the Utilities Menu. 3.) Select the Buttons tab on the Connectivity screen. 4.) In the Physical Print Button field, select Print3. 5.) In the Destinations list, select the service(s) recorded in step 5, Section 7-4-1. 6.) In the Physical Print Buttons section, select the parameters related to the service recorded in step 6, Section 7-4-1. Figure 7-6 7-8 Section 7-4 - Screen Captures GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 7-5 Wire - LAN Network 1.) If user wants to setup static IP address, uncheck Enable DHCP option, input static address in IP-Address box, Subnet Mask and Default Gateway box. In Network Speed box, choose the proper speed available. 2.) Click Save, in popped-up dialog and choose Ok. 3.) After reboot, the cross mark on the network icon at the left bottom of screen disappears. Chapter 7 Diagnostics/Troubleshooting 7-9 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 7-6 Troubleshooting 7-6-1 Console Troubleshooting Trees 7-6-1-1 System Doesn’t Boot This is an overall diagram showing a recommended sequence for troubleshooting a no-boot situation. NOTE: Issues Includes 1)System does not Switch ON OR System does not complete the bootup process. System doesn’t boot! Is the power On/Off LED in Amber color lit? NO YES Press ON/OFF Button Are the LEDs on PDB module lit? YES Does power On/Off LED is Green ? NO NO Check 220vac +/-10%at i/p available to the transformer by conforming whether stand by led is lit. 1) Check cable connections from KBD to PDB 2) If problem persists, replace PDB Module & the Cable b/w PDB & KBD. Check main cable between KBD and PDB board. NO YES Go on to the next page. Replace PDB board. Figure 7-7 System Doesn’t Boot (cont’d) 7-10 Section 7-6 - Troubleshooting GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 7-6-1-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL System Doesn’t Boot (cont’d) System doesn’t boot! (con’d) YES NO Is BIOS screen displayed on the LCD? Is BIOS screen displayed on external Monitor? NO YES Check flat Ribbon cable B/W DCK & RPI NO 1) Check LCD brightness. 2) Check LCD Power & Signal Cable. 3) Check LCD & Replace if found defective else replace MST+DCK. Is “LOGIQ P3” starting to display on the LCD? NO YES Replace TMST PWA. Reboot system, if still can’t boot up, please replace TMST assy. YES Reboot the system and Reload latest system & Application software with DVD-RW. Go to Scan Procedure section. Figure 7-8 System Doesn’t Boot (cont’d) Chapter 7 Diagnostics/Troubleshooting 7-11 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 7-6-1-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL B Mode Low Sensitivity B Mode sensitivity is low! NO Is Image sensitivity recovered after changing probe? NO Is low sensitivity for all types of probe? YES YES Replace the probe with low sensitivity. check HV voltages on the Service Diagnostics? NO Refer to Ch.6 Service Adjustment to adjust LCD brightness. YES YES Reload application SW is OK? NO Run Service diagnostics and replace defective board YES END END Figure 7-9 B Mode Low Sensitivity 7-12 Check the HV power supply unit on TX64, refer to error code list. Section 7-6 - Troubleshooting GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 7-6-1-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL B Mode Low Image Quality ROD SCAN Transducer Scan Area B Mode image quality is low! Screwdriver YES Is irregular pattern found by rod scan? Reconnect the probe & check. NO YES Are low sensitivity and lack of sensitivity found by rod scan? Check Conn Board,TX64, TMST, RX64, refer to error code list. NO NO Is the scanner set to the proper configuration? YES Replace failed board. Reset the system configuration as default i.e reload the factory defaults. YES Adjust the brightness of LCD display. End Figure 7-10 B Mode Low Image Quality Chapter 7 Diagnostics/Troubleshooting 7-13 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 7-6-1-4 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Noise in B Mode Noise in B Mode. Note: Run Service Diagnostic test, refer sec 7-7 for diagnostic test NO Check & ensure system is grounded using 3 pin connector on mains? Set the functional grounding. YES Is there any electrical devices that affect the Scanner? YES Keep the Scanner away from those electrical devices. NO NO If the probe connect properly? 1) Re-connect the probe. 2) Check the probe, whether it is broken on the surface. YES Is the PDB,TX64, RX64 assembled properly? YES Is the shielding emi cover assembled properly? YES Are all cable located in right place? YES NO Ensure board connection. NO Assemble it properly. NO Route it properly. END Figure 7-11 Noise in B Mode 7-14 Section 7-6 - Troubleshooting GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 7-6-1-5 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Color Flow Low Sensitivity Color Flow sensitivity is low. Is the sensitivity normal for B Mode? YES Note: Run Service Diagnostic test, Refer sec 7-7 for diagnostic test NO Go to B Mode Low Sensitivity section. Is the sensitivity low for all types of probe? YES NO Check the probes. Is the sensitivity low for all area of the ROI? YES NO Check TMST board, refer to error code list. Is Conn board power supply on TX64 ok? NO YES Check RX64 board Replace the TX64 board. Figure 7-12 Color Flow Low Sensitivity Chapter 7 Diagnostics/Troubleshooting 7-15 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 7-6-1-6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Spectrum Doppler Low Sensitivity Spectrum Doppler sensitivity is low. Is the sensitivity normal for B Mode? Note: Run Service Diagnostic test, Refer sec 7-7 for diagnostic test NO Go to B Mode Low Sensitivity section. YES Is the sensitivity low for all types of probe? YES NO Check the probes. YES Is Conn board power supply on TX64 ok? NO Check the RX64 board. Replace the TX64 board. Figure 7-13 Spectrum Doppler Low Sensitivity 7-16 Section 7-6 - Troubleshooting GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 7-6-1-7 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Noise in Color Flow Noise in Color Flow. YES Is there any electrical devices that affect the Scanner. Keep the Scanner away from those electrical devices. NO NO Is the System Ground taken in right way? YES Set the System Ground. Does the noise vary according to probe cable routing? YES Replace the probe. NO Is the TX64, RX64 & Flex Cables assembled or inserted properly? NO Re Insert the PWAS & Cables & Screw the screws. YES Is the shielding emi cover assembled properly? YES Assemble it properly. Are all cable located & Inserted properly in right YES NO NO Route it properly. END Figure 7-14 Noise in Color Flow Chapter 7 Diagnostics/Troubleshooting 7-17 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 7-6-1-8 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Scan Procedure Unable to scan on any of the Ports! NO Is probe connected in right way? YES Check the probe connection. Whether the system can display the probe name? NO YES Whether the probe connected well? YES YES Is the system in Freeze status? NO Whether the system can be unfreezes? NO Go to the next page. 1) Check KBD. YES 2) Check TMST. 1) Check Connector Board,TX,RX and TMST. 2)Check TMST to RX Flex cable 3) Check the wire connection UnFreeze the system. Figure 7-15 Unable to Scan 7-18 Section 7-6 - Troubleshooting NO Reconnect the probe. GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 7-6-1-8 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Scan Procedure (cont’d) Unable to scan! (con’d) Increase the Gain. YES Is there back ground noise? NO YES Restart the system. Is TMST2TX ok? YES NO Replace TMST2TX board. NO Is TX64 ok? YES Is Flex cables ok? YES Replace TX64 board. NO Replace Flex cables. Restart the system. Figure 7-16 Unable to scan (con’d) Chapter 7 Diagnostics/Troubleshooting 7-19 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 7-6-1-9 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Trackball The trackball is low sensitive! Doesn’t the trackball move at all? NO YES Remove the ball from the Trackball, and clean it. The trackball module is defective and replace it in Key board. END Figure 7-17 Trackball 7-20 Section 7-6 - Troubleshooting GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 7-6-1-10 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL LCD Display Error on the LCD display! Does the LCD display nothing? NO YES Check the cable from Docking board to LCD also check LCD. Does the colors seem abnormal? YES Check cable from Docking board to LCD. NO Does the Brightness adjustment seem improper? YES Set up the brightness. NO Check the LCD Assy END Figure 7-18 LCD Display Chapter 7 Diagnostics/Troubleshooting 7-21 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 7-6-2 7-6-2-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Peripheral Troubleshooting Trees Unable Recording by Printer Unable to record by the Printer! Is the connection set in the right way? NO 1) Check power supply connection to the printer. YES 2) Check the printer connection to the system. Are there printer papers left? YES NO Insert the printer papers. Is the proper configuration for P* key set? YES NO Set the P* key by the Utility menu. Change printer. END Figure 7-19 Unable Recording by Printer 7-22 Section 7-6 - Troubleshooting GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 7-6-2-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Drive Issue DVD-RW Unable to record by the DVD-RW! Is the connection set in the right way? YES NO Check all signal and power supply connections. Is there blank DVD-R disk inside? NO Insert the blank DVD-R. YES Is the blank has been formatted? NO Format the DVD YES Change DVD-RW. END Figure 7-20 Unable Recording by DVD-RW Chapter 7 Diagnostics/Troubleshooting 7-23 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 7-6-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL LCD Troubleshooting LCD does not work - Check if LCD is getting power. - Check if LCD Video signal cable is connected properly on either end. Colored stains appear in image 7-6-4 7-6-4-1 - Check for Video cable of LCD. - Change LCD setting in system. - Replace the LCD. Network Troubleshooting Trees No Connection to the Network at All 1.) Check if the LCD indicates the network connection is working in normal status. Click Start button on the bottom left of the status bar, select Network Connections. (refer to 7-69) Figure 7-21 Start menu a.) Check whether your Wireless Network Connection or Local Area Connection is installed successfully. (refer to Figure 7-70) Figure 7-22 Network Connection 7-24 Section 7-6 - Troubleshooting GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 7-6-4-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL No Connection to the Network at All (cont’d) 2.) Check that the network cable between the scanner and the wall network is connected and well seated in both ends. 3.) Try a network cable that is known to be OK. 4.) Connect a network cable between the Scanner and your PC. Try to ping from the scanner to the IP address on the PC. If ok, the hardware connection inside the scanner is OK. Chapter 7 Diagnostics/Troubleshooting 7-25 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 7-26 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 7-6 - Troubleshooting GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures Section 8-1 Overview 8-1-1 Purpose of Chapter 8 This chapter describes replacement procedures for the following modules and subsystems. Table 8-1 Contents in Chapter 8 Section Description Page Number 8-1 Overview 8-1 8-2 Disassembly/Re-assembly of LOGIQ P3 8-2 8-2-1 Warning and Caution 8-2 8-2-2 Returning/Shipping for repairs 8-2 8-2-3 Standard tools list for LOGIQ P3 8-3 8-2-4 LCD Assy (FRU P/N: 5315112-LP3, 5396925-LP3 BT10) 8-4 8-2-5 LCD Arm Cover (FRU P/N: 5310093) 8-8 8-2-6 Handle P3 Console (FRU P/N: 5315120) 8-9 8-2-7 Keyboard Assembly (FRU P/N: 5314404) 8-10 8-2-8 TGC PWA FRU Assy (FRU P/N: 5315107) 8-14 8-2-9 Alpha Numeric Keyboard with cables (FRU P/N: 5315106) 8-16 8-3 Keyboard Rear Cover Assy (FRU P/N: 5315122) 8-20 8-4 Mechanicals 8-24 8-5 USB Cable Set (FRU P/N: 5315039) 8-48 Rear Panel Assy (110V FRU P/N: 5315503/ 220V FRU P/N: 5315504) - LOGIQ P3 8-54 8-6 RX Board (FRU P/N: 5315027) 8-63 8-7 Power Block - LOGIQ P3 8-69 8-8 Key Caps (FRU P/N: 5315124) 8-74 8-9 DVD Drive 8-76 8-10 Power Cable 8-77 8-12 Signal Cable Set (FRU P/N: 5315042) 8-80 8-13 Power Cable Set (FRU P/N: 5315036) 8-82 8-5-4 Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-1 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 Table 8-1 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Contents in Chapter 8 Section 8-14 PROPRIETARY TO GE Description Page Number Loading Base Image Software 8-86 Section 8-2 Disassembly/Re-assembly of LOGIQ P3 8-2-1 WARNING Warning and Caution ONLY QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL SHOULD REMOVE ANY COVERS OR PANELS. ELECTRICAL HAZARDS EXISTS AT SEVERAL POINTS INSIDE. BECOME THOROUGHLY FAMILIAR WITH ALL HAZARDOUS VOLTAGES AND HIGH CURRENT LEVELS TO AVOID ACCIDENTAL CONTACT CAUTION Do not wear the ESD wrist strap when you remove a part of power supply unit. Turn OFF power and unplug the power cord before removing a part of power supply unit. 8-2-2 Returning/Shipping for repairs Equipment being returned must be clean, free of blood and other infectious substances. GEHC policy states that body fluids must be properly removed from every part or equipment prior to shipment. GEHC employees, as well as customers, are responsible for ensuring that parts/equipment have been decontaminated prior to shipment. Under no circumstances should a part or equipment with visible fluids be taken or shipped from a clinic or site (For example: body coils or an ultrasound probe). The purpose of the regulation is to protect employees in the transportation industry, as well as the people who receives or opens the package. NOTE: 8-2 The US Department of Transportation (DOT) has ruled that “items that were saturated and/or dripping with human blood that are now caked with dried blood; or which were used or intended to use in patient care” are “regulated medical waste” for transportation purposes and must be transported as a hazardous material. Section 8-2 - Disassembly/Re-assembly of LOGIQ P3 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-2-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Standard tools list for LOGIQ P3 Table 8-2 Standard tools list No Part Name Screw Description Screwdriver Description 1 screw Screwdriver, Stubby Phillips #2 2 screw 1/4 in. Standard.Socket set (19 pc) Xcelite-hex Blade 5/32 inch 3 screw Screwdriver, Slotted 1/4 in.X 6 in. Steel rule Metric 6 inch 4 screw Screw FH M2.5x3 (NL) Phillips #1 5 screw Screw SFH M2.5x4 (NL) Phillips #1 6 screw Screw FH M2.5x5 (NL) Phillips #1 7 screw Screw FHE M2.5x5 (NL) Phillips #1 8 screw Screw SJ2836-87 M2.5X6 (I) Phillips #1 9 screw SCREW SJ2836-87 M2.5x12 (II) Phillips #1 10 screw D2 SCREW M3X3-NYLOK Phillips #1 11 screw Screw FH M3X6 (NL) Phillips #1 12 screw D2 SCREW SJ2836-87 M3X8 Phillips #2 13 screw Screw BN5687 M3X10 (NL) TORX#10 14 screw Screw FH M3X13 (NL) Phillips #1 15 screw Screw SJ2836-87 M3X18 (I) Phillips #2 16 screw Screw M3x25 (NL) TORX#10 17 screw Screw M4x12 TORX#10 NOTE: Please use the correct Screwdrivers listed in Table 8-2 on LOGIQ P3. NOTE: After Replacement of the Hardware Boards on LOGIQ P3BT10, please perform Shutdown and Reboot. Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-3 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-2-4 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL LCD Assy (FRU P/N: 5315112-LP3, 5396925-LP3 BT10) Purpose: This is a description on how to remove and replace the LCD Assy. 8-2-4-1 8-2-4-2 Tools • Common phillips screwdrivers • Allen/Unbraco wrench Needed Manpower • 8-2-4-3 Preparations • 8-2-4-4 1 person, 11 minutes + travel Shut Down the System Switch of the circuit breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal procedure 1) Shut down the Logiq P3 system. 2) LCD monitor rearcover of Logiq P3 system.as shown below Figure 8-1 on page 8-4 LCD Rear cover LCD power cable cover LCD Arm cover Figure 8-1 LCD rear cover 3) Bend down the LCD monitor by 90 degree. 4) Bend the LCD monitor as shown below Figure 8-2 on page 8-5 8-4 Section 8-2 - Disassembly/Re-assembly of LOGIQ P3 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-2-4 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL LCD Assy (FRU P/N: 5315112-LP3, 5396925-LP3 BT10) (cont’d) 5) Use minus screw driver and remove the power cable cover. Refer Figure 8-2 on page 8-5 Power cable cover Figure 8-2 Power cable cover 6) Remove the Power cable cover of LCD monitor as shown below Figure 8-3 on page 8-5 7) unfasten the cable clamp for power cable and DVI cables and conncted to the LCD monitor Refer Figure 8-3 on page 8-5 Cable Clamp Power Cable DVI Cable Figure 8-3 Power cable & DVI cable (LOGIQ P3) Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-5 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Figure 8-4 Power cable & DVI cable (LOGIQ P3 BT10) 8) disconnect the power cable & DVI cable from the LCD monitor system.Refer Figure 8-5 on page 8-6 power cable DVI cable Figure 8-5 Remove Power cable & DVI cable 8-6 Section 8-2 - Disassembly/Re-assembly of LOGIQ P3 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 9) Loosen the two screw of (A,B) of LCD monitor Arm.Refer Figure 8-6 on page 8-7 A B Figure 8-6 LCD monitor neck 10) Lift the LCD Assembly upward to remove it from the system. Refer Figure 8-7 on page 8-7 Figure 8-7 Lift LCD monitor 8-2-4-5 Mounting Procedure 1) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-2-4-6 Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional Test 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown 4-3-4 Adjusting the Display Monitor Debrief Script Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-2-3. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-7 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-2-5 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL LCD Arm Cover (FRU P/N: 5310093) This is a description on how to remove and replace the LCD Arm cover set. 8-2-5-1 Tools • 8-2-5-2 Needed Manpower • 8-2-5-3 1 person, 15 minutes Preparations • 8-2-5-4 Common phillips screwdrivers Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal procedure 1) Remove LCD Power Cable cover & LCD Signal Cable Refer Refer section Section 8-3 on page 20 2) Remove LCD Arm cover Assembly .as shown below Figure 8-8 on page 8-8 a b Remove two screws of Arm Cover Arm Cover Figure 8-8 LCD Arm cover & monitor neck cover 8-2-5-5 Mounting procedure 1.) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-2-5-6 Functional Checkout Procedure Functional Test Debrief Script Do Visual Inspection and ensure Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-2-4. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. no scratches observed and fitment is done properly 8-8 Section 8-2 - Disassembly/Re-assembly of LOGIQ P3 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-2-6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Handle P3 Console (FRU P/N: 5315120) This is a description on how to remove and replace the Handle P3 console Assembly. 8-2-6-1 Tools • 8-2-6-2 Needed Manpower • 8-2-6-3 1 person, 15 minutes Preparations • 8-2-6-4 Common phillips screwdrivers; Allen Key Set. Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal procedure 1) Remove keyboard Top cover and Pull out the keyboard top assembly cover by the slot marked in the Figure 8-9 on page 8-9 2) Remove Gel holder and probe holder. Refer Refer section 8-3-1 on page 223) Using the allen key set remove Handle P3 console by unfastening the two socket head fasteners marked (1,2,3) in the Figure 8-9 on page 8-9 handle P3 console Gel holder Probe holder Figure 8-9 Handle P3 console 8-2-6-5 Mounting procedure 1.) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-2-6-6 Functional Checkout Procedure Functional Test Debrief Script Do Visual Inspection and ensure Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-2-5. Equipment passes all required no scratches observed and tests and is ready for use. fitment is done properly Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-9 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-2-7 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Keyboard Assembly (FRU P/N: 5314404) This is a description on how to remove and replace the keyboard Assembly. 8-2-7-1 Tools • 8-2-7-2 Common Torx screwdrivers Needed Manpower • 1person, 10 minutes Note: The Freeze key is part of Keyboard. 8-2-7-3 Preparations • 8-2-7-4 Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal Procedure 1) Unscrew the three screws (A,B,C) of keyboard bottom cover of the system. Refer Figure 8-10 on page 8-10 A B C Remove the three screws as shown. Figure 8-10 keyboard Bottom view 8-10 Section 8-2 - Disassembly/Re-assembly of LOGIQ P3 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 2) Lift the Keyboard Top view Assembly of Logiq P3 system.Refer Figure 8-11 on page 8-11 Figure 8-11 Move the keyboard out in the given direction 3) Remove USB cable from keyboard PCB Assembly of system.ReferFigure 8-12 on page 8-11 USB cable Figure 8-12 keyboard cable Location 4) Remove keyboard interface cable from keyboard Assembly of the system. Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-11 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Refer Figure 8-13 on page 8-12 keyboard interface cable Figure 8-13 keyboard cable Location 5) Remove cable from keyboard Assembly of the system. Refer Figure 8-14 on page 8-12 Figure 8-14 keyboard cable Location 8-2-7-5 Mounting procedure 1.) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-2-7-6 Replace Keyboard Assembly 1.) Connect keyboard cable to the new Keyboard Assembly. 2.) Locate the Keyboard top hinge appropriately. 8-12 Section 8-2 - Disassembly/Re-assembly of LOGIQ P3 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 3.) Replace keyboard Assembly by fixing three screws (a,b,c ). 4.) Refix Gel holder and Probe holders. 8-2-7-7 Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional Test Debrief Script 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-2-6. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-13 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-2-8 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL TGC PWA FRU Assy (FRU P/N: 5315107) This is a description on how to remove and replace the TGC PWA Assembly. 8-2-8-1 Tools • 8-2-8-2 Needed Manpower • 8-2-8-3 1 person, 10 minutes Preparations • 8-2-8-4 Common phillips screwdrivers Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal procedure 1) Remove keyboard Assembly. Refer Refer section 8-2-7 on page 10 2) Remove TGC Caps. ( 8 Nos.) 3) Remove TGC assembly by removing the four screws (as marked in Figure 8-15 on page 8-15 ) PWA with TGC interface cable. 8-14 Section 8-2 - Disassembly/Re-assembly of LOGIQ P3 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL TGC Assembly TGC Interface cable Figure 8-15 TGC PCB 8-2-8-5 Mounting procedure 1.) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-2-8-6 Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional Test 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown 4-3-6 B Mode Checks Debrief Script Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-2-7. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-15 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-2-9 8-2-9-1 Tools 1 person, 30 minutes Preparations • 8-2-9-4 Common phillips screwdrivers Needed Manpower • 8-2-9-3 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Alpha Numeric Keyboard with cables (FRU P/N: 5315106) • 8-2-9-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal procedure 1) Remove Keyboard Assembly.Refer section 8-2-7 on page 10 2) Remove the Alphanumeric Keyboard by unfastening the 10 screws (marked in Red color in Figure 8-16 on page 8-16 ) holding it & the Alphanumeric keyboard cable. 10 Screws A/N Keyboard Figure 8-16 Alpha Numeric keyboard PCB 8-2-9-5 Mounting procedure 1.) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-16 Section 8-2 - Disassembly/Re-assembly of LOGIQ P3 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-2-9-6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional Test 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown 4-3-6 B Mode Checks Debrief Script Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-2-8. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-17 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-2-10 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Optical Trackball Assy (FRU P/N: 5315029) This is a description on how to remove and replace the Optical Trackball Assembly. 8-2-10-1 Tools • 8-2-10-2 Needed Manpower • 8-2-10-3 1 person, 10 minutes Preparations • 8-2-10-4 Common phillips screwdrivers Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal procedure 1) Remove Keyboard Assembly. Refer section 8-2-7 on page 10. 2) Unfasten the 2 screws(A,B) holding the trackball bracket (circled in Yellow color in Figure 8-17 on page 8-18 ) 3) Remove Trackball assembly with Trackball Interface cable.Refer Figure 8-17 on page 8-18 A 2 screws to be removed B Figure 8-17 Optical Trackball Assembly 8-2-10-5 Mounting procedure 1.) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-18 Section 8-2 - Disassembly/Re-assembly of LOGIQ P3 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-2-10-6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional Test 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown 4-3-6 B Mode Checks Debrief Script Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-2-9. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-19 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 8-3Keyboard Rear Cover Assy (FRU P/N: 5315122) This is a description on how to remove and replace the keyboard cover Assembly. 8-3-0-1 Tools • 8-3-0-2 Needed Manpower • 8-3-0-3 1 person, 15 minutes Preparations • 8-3-0-4 Common phillips screwdrivers Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal procedure 1) Remove Keyboard assembly. Refer Section 8-2-6 B A Figure 8-18 Keyboard 2) Remove the 2 screws (A,B) as shown in the figure above. 3) Remove LCD Arm cover as mentioned. Refer section 8-2-4 on page 8- 7 8-20 Section 8-3 - Keyboard Rear Cover Assy (FRU P/N: 5315122) GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 4) Remove the keyboard rear cover as shown below Figure 8-19 on page 8-21 Keyboard rear cover Figure 8-19 keyboard rear cover 8-3-0-5 Mounting procedure 1.) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-3-0-6 Functional Checkout Procedure Functional Test Debrief Script Do Visual Inspection and ensure Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-3-1. Equipment passes all required no scratches observed and tests and is ready for use. fitment is done properly Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-21 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-3-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Probe Holder (FRU P/N: 5168500) / Gel Bottle Holder (FRU P/N: 5168636) This is a description on how to remove and replace the Probe holder Assembly. 8-3-1-1 Needed Manpower • 8-3-1-2 Preparations • 8-3-1-3 1 person, 15 minutes Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal procedure 1) Pull the probe holder out by slightly pushing it upwards with your hands. Refer Figure 8-20 on page 8-22 Gel Holder Probe Holder Figure 8-20 Probe Holder 8-3-1-4 Mounting procedure 1.) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-3-1-5 Functional Checkout Procedure Functional Test Debrief Script Do Visual Inspection and ensure Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-3-2. Equipment passes all required no scratches observed and tests and is ready for use. fitment is done properly 8-22 Section 8-3 - Keyboard Rear Cover Assy (FRU P/N: 5315122) GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-3-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Keyboard Knob Set (FRU P/N: 5315502 ) & Encoder set (FRU P/N: 5262796) This is a description on how to remove and replace the Keyboard knob set Assembly. 8-3-2-1 Tools • NOTE: 8-3-2-2 B Mode Gain Knob Encoder is not a FRU. Needed Manpower • 8-3-2-3 1 person, 15 minutes Preparations • 8-3-2-4 Common phillips screwdrivers Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal procedure 1) Pull the knobs out with hands by slightly pushing it up from the bottom edge.Refer Figure 8-21 on page 8-23 Encoder knob Depth Knob TGC Knob Figure 8-21 Keyboard knob set 8-3-2-5 Mounting procedure 1.) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-3-2-6 Functional Checkout Procedure Functional Test Debrief Script Do Visual Inspection and ensure Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-3-3. Equipment passes all required no scratches observed and tests and is ready for use. fitment is done properly Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-23 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 8-4Mechanicals 8-4-1 RH Side Cover (FRU No :5315115) This is a description on how to remove and replace the Right Cover. 8-4-1-1 Tools • 8-4-1-2 Needed Manpower • 8-4-1-3 1 person, 15 minutes Preparations • 8-4-1-4 Common Torx screwdrivers Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal Procedure 1) Remove the screw cap of four places(1,2,3,4,) on RH-side cover of the system. Refer Figure 8-22 on page 8-24 2) Remove the RH-side cover from the system. Refer Figure 8-22 on page 8-24 Screw Cap RH-Cover Figure 8-22 RH-side cover 3) Remove the RH-side cover four screws(1, 2, 3, 4) of the system. Refer Figure 8-23 on page 8-25 8-24 Section 8-4 - Mechanicals GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Figure 8-23 RH-side cover 8-4-1-5 Mounting procedure 1.) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-4-1-6 Functional Checkout Procedure Functional Test Debrief Script Do Visual Inspection and ensure Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-4-1. Equipment passes all required no scratches observed and tests and is ready for use. fitment is done properly Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-25 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-4-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL LH Side Cover (FRU No: 5315114) This is a description on how to remove and replace the Left Cover. 8-4-2-1 Tools • 8-4-2-2 Needed Manpower • 8-4-2-3 1person, 15 minutes Preparations • 8-4-2-4 Common Torx screwdrivers Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal Procedure 1.) Remove the screw cap of four places (1,2,3,4). 2.) Unscrew 4 screws (1,2,3,4). 3.) Remove the Left cover in the direction as shown in the figure below. Screw cap LH-Cover Figure 8-24 Left Cover 8-4-2-5 Mounting procedure 1.) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-4-2-6 Functional Checkout Procedure Functional Test Debrief Script Do Visual Inspection and ensure Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-4--2. Equipment passes all required no scratches observed and tests and is ready for use. fitment is done properly 8-26 Section 8-4 - Mechanicals GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-4-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Rear Cover (FRU No. 5315117) Purpose: This is a description on how to remove and replace the Rear Cover. 8-4-3-1 Tools • 8-4-3-2 Needed Manpower • 8-4-3-3 1 persons, 15 minutes Preparations • 8-4-3-4 Common Phillips screwdrivers Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal Procedure 1.) Remove RH-side cover from the system.Refer section 8-4-1 on page 24 2) Remove LH-side cover from the system.Refer section 8-4-2 on page 26 3) Remove the two screws (A,B) RH- side from the system.Refer Figure 8-27 on page 8-28 Figure 8-25 Rear cover 5) Loosen the two screws (A,B) LH- side from the system.Refer Figure 8-26 on page 8-27 Figure 8-26 Removing screws of rear cover Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-27 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 6) Loosen Rear cover RH-Side from the system.Refer Figure 8-27 on page 8-28 Figure 8-27 Removing screws of rear cover 8-4-3-5 Mounting procedure 1.) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal 8-4-3-6 Functional Checkout Procedure Functional Test Debrief Script Do Visual Inspection and ensure Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-4--3. Equipment passes all required no scratches observed and tests and is ready for use. fitment is done properly 8-28 Section 8-4 - Mechanicals GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-4-4 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Front Cover (FRU No.5315116 ) This is a description on how to remove and replace the Front Cover. 8-4-4-1 Tools • 8-4-4-2 Needed Manpower • 8-4-4-3 1 persons, 15 minutes Preparations • 8-4-4-4 Common Phillips screwdrivers Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal Procedure 1) Remove the RH-side cover from the system.Refer section 8-4-1 on page 24 2) Remove the LH-side cover from the system.Refer section 8-4-2 on page 26 Front Cover Figure 8-28 Front cover 3)Remove the two screws (A,B) LH- side of the system. Refer Figure 8-29 on page 8-30 Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-29 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Figure 8-29 Removing side screws of front cover 4) Remove the two screws (A,B) RH- side of the system. Refer Figure 8-30 on page 8-30 Figure 8-30 Removing side screws of front cover 8-4-4-5 Mounting procedure 1.) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-30 Section 8-4 - Mechanicals GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-4-4-6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Functional Checkout Procedure Functional Test Debrief Script Do Visual Inspection and ensure Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-4--4. Equipment passes all required no scratches observed and tests and is ready for use. fitment is done properly Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-31 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-4-5 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Top Cover (FRU P/N: 5315121) This is a description on how to remove and replace the Top cover Assembly. 8-4-5-1 Tools • 8-4-5-2 Needed Manpower • 8-4-5-3 1person, 15 minutes Preparations • 8-4-5-4 Common Phillips screwdrivers Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal Procedure 1) Remove the LH-side cover from the system. Refer section 8-4-2 on page 26 2) Remove the RH-side cover from the system. Refer section 8-4-1 on page 24 3) Remove the Front cover from the system. Refer section 8-4-4 on page 29 4) Remove the Rear cover from the system. Refer section 8-4-7 on page 36 5) loosen two screws (A.B) in front side of top cover from the system. Refer Figure 8-31 on page 8-32 B A Figure 8-31 Top cover 8-32 Section 8-4 - Mechanicals GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 6) Remove the LH-side Emi cover and remove two screws from LH -side Bottom of the top assembly of the system.Refer Figure 8-32 on page 8-33 Figure 8-32 Removing screw top assembly 7) Remove RH-side Emi cover and remove two screws from RH -side bottom of the top assembly of the system. Refer Figure 8-33 on page 8-33 Figure 8-33 Removing screw top assembly Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-33 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 8) Remove the top whole assembly by pulling the top assembly front side from the system. Refer Figure 8-34 on page 8-34 Figure 8-34 Top assembly 9) The top assembly should be to removed from two locating pins (A,B). Refer Figure 8-35 on page 8-34 A B Figure 8-35 Top assembly 8-4-5-5 Mounting procedure 1.) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-4-5-6 Functional Checkout Procedure Functional Test Debrief Script Do Visual Inspection and ensure Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-4-5. Equipment passes all required no scratches observed and tests and is ready for use. fitment is done properly 8-34 Section 8-4 - Mechanicals GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 8-4-6 Caster Wheel Front (FRU P/N :5315118 - LP3, 5368246 - LP3BT10) / Caster Wheel Rear (FRU P/N: 5315119 - LP3, 5368247 - LP3 BT10) This is a description on how to remove and replace the castor wheel front and castor wheel rear . 8-4-6-1 Tools • 8-4-6-2 Needed Manpower • 8-4-6-3 1person, 15 minutes each Preparations • 8-4-6-4 Common Phillips screwdrivers; Allen Key Set. Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal Procedure 1) Remove the Transformer assy. Refer section 8-7-1 on page 69 2) Lift the system slightly up on the side of the castor wheel that needs replacement 3) Place a small block of the size of castor wheel to balance the system 4) Using the allen key set, unfasten the 4 Hex screws holding the Castor wheel and remove it Refer Figure 8-36 on page 8-35 Figure 8-36 Castor wheel 8-4-6-5 Mounting procedure 1.) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-4-6-6 Functional Checkout Procedure Functional Test Debrief Script Do Visual Inspectionand roll system Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-4-6. Equipment passes all required around and ensure smooth wheel tests and is ready for use. rotation and sweivwl Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-35 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-4-7 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Rear EMI Cover (Part of EMI Cover Assy FRU P/N: 5315111) This is a description on how to remove and replace the Right EMI Cover (P/N :5308951). 8-4-7-1 Tools • 8-4-7-2 Needed Manpower • 8-4-7-3 1 person, 15 minutes Preparations • 8-4-7-4 Common phillips screwdrivers Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal Procedure 1) Remove Right cover. Refer section 8-4-3 on page 27 for details on how to remove Right cover. 2) Remove rear cover. Refer section 8-4-3 on page 27 3)Use the scewdriver and Loose the Five screws (1,2,3,4,5) 4) Remove Rear-side EMI cover. Refer Figure 8-37 on page 8-36 for details on how to remove Rear cover. Rear-side EMI cover Figure 8-37 Rear-side EMI cover 8-4-7-5 Mounting procedure Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal 8-4-7-6 Functional Checkout Procedure Functional Test Debrief Script Do Visual Inspection and ensure Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-4-7. Equipment passes all required no scratches observed and tests and is ready for use. fitment is done properly 8-36 Section 8-4 - Mechanicals GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-4-8 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Right EMI Cover (Part of EMI Cover Assy FRU P/N: 5315111) This is a description on how to remove and replace the Right EMI Cover (P/N :5308965). 8-4-8-1 Tools • 8-4-8-2 Needed Manpower • 8-4-8-3 1 person, 15 minutes Preparations • 8-4-8-4 Common phillips screwdrivers Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal Procedure 1) Remove Right cover. Refer section 8-4-3 on page 27 for details on how to remove Right cover. 2) Use the scewdriver and Loose the eight screws (1,2,3,4,5,6,7,8) 3) Slide and remove RH-side EMI cover. Refer Figure 8-38 on page 8-37 for details on how to remove Right cover. 4 5 6 3 RH-side EMI cover Slide to right to re-install cover 7 2 Slide to left to remove the cover 8 1 Figure 8-38 RH-side EMI cover 8-4-8-5 Mounting procedure Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-37 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-4-8-6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Functional Checkout Procedure Functional Test Debrief Script Do Visual Inspection and ensure Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-4--8. Equipment passes all required no scratches observed and tests and is ready for use. fitment is done properly 8-38 Section 8-4 - Mechanicals GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-4-9 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Left EMI Cover (Part of EMI Cover Assy FRU P/N: 5315111) This is a description on how to remove and replace the Left EMI Cover.(P/N : 5308964) 8-4-9-1 Tools • 8-4-9-2 Needed Manpower • 8-4-9-3 1person, 15 minutes Preparations • 8-4-9-4 Common Phillips screwdrivers Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal Procedure 1) Remove Left cover. Refer section 8-4-1 on page 24 for details on how to remove Left cover. 3) eight screws to be unfastened of LH -side EMI cover of Logiq P3 system. Refer Figure 8-39 on page 8-39 2) Remove LH- side EMI cover. Refer Figure 8-39 on page 8-39 for details on how to remove Left cover. 4 3 6 Slide this way to remove the cover Slide this way to reinstall the cover 2 7 1 8 Figure 8-39 LH -side EMI cover 4) Use Screwdriver & Loose eight screws (1,2,3,4,5,6,7,8,), from LH-side EMI cover of Logiq P3 system Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-39 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Refer Figure 8-40 on page 8-40 Figure 8-40 Loosen screw of LH- side EMI cover 5) Remove LH- side EMI cover of Logiq P3 system. Refer Figure 8-41 on page 8-40 Figure 8-41 Remove LH- side EMI cover 8-4-9-5 Mounting procedure Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-4-9-6 Functional Checkout Procedure Functional Test Debrief Script Do Visual Inspection and ensure Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-4-9. Equipment passes all required no scratches observed and tests and is ready for use. fitment is done properly 8-40 Section 8-4 - Mechanicals GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 8-4-10 MST BOARD ASSEMBLY ( P/N: 5315025 - LP3, 5388844 - LP3BT10) SOM (P/N: 5308994 - LP3, 5308994 - LP3Bt10) This is a description on how to remove and replace the cable assembly of MST board and SOM. 8-4-10-1 Tools • 8-4-10-2 Needed Manpower • 8-4-10-3 Common Phillips screwdrivers 1person, 15 minutes Preparations Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system 8-4-10-4 Removal Procedure 1) Removal of all cable assembly from MST to TX as shown below Figure 8-42 on page 8-41 2) Use a screwdriver to remove the two screw holding the flexi cable to the MST board. Refer Figure 8-42 on page 8-41 Flexi cable Figure 8-42 Removing Flexi cable of MST board Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-41 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 3) Remove USB cable from MST board Refer Figure 8-43 on page 8-42 USB cable Figure 8-43 Removing USB cable of MST board 4) For LOGIQ P3 - Remove the FRC cable from MST board Refer Figure 8-44 on page 8-42 FRC cable Figure 8-44 Removing FRC cable of MST board 5) For LOGIQ P3BT10 - Remove the Video signal (VGA) cable from MST board as shown below. 8-42 Section 8-4 - Mechanicals GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Figure 8-45 Removing the VGA cable 6) Remove the Audio cable from MST board Refer Figure 8-46 on page 8-43 Audio cable Figure 8-46 Removing Audio cable of MST board Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-43 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 7) Remove the Power cable from MST board Refer Figure 8-47 on page 8-44 Power cable Figure 8-47 Removing Power cable of MST board 8) Loosen the 4 screws and slide the MST assembly as shown in the Fig A. Slide this way to Remove Fig B SOM Fig A After removing the MST PCB on the other side remove the four screws to remove SOM as shown in Fig B. Figure 8-48 MST Assy (LOGIQ P3) 8-44 Section 8-4 - Mechanicals GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Figure 8-49 MST Assy (LOGIQ P3BT10) 8-4-10-5 Mounting procedure Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-4-10-6 Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional Test 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown 4-3-6 B Mode Checks 4-3-7 M Mode Controls 4-3-8 Color Flow Mode Checks 4-3-9 Doppler Mode Checks Debrief Script Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-4-10. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-45 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-4-11 8-4-11-1 Tools Common Phillips screwdrivers Needed Manpower • 8-4-11-3 LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL HARD DISK DRIVE ASSEMBLY ( PART NO:5315113) • 8-4-11-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE 1person, 15 minutes Preparations Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system 8-4-11-4 Removal Procedure 1) Remove Right side cover and Right side EMI cover. Refer Section 8-4-8 on page 8-37 2) Loosen the One screw (A) and pull out the hard disk drive assembly as shown in Figure 8-50 on page 8-46 Screw (A) HDD Power cable Figure 8-50 Removing Hard Disk Drive Power cable 8-46 Section 8-4 - Mechanicals GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 3) Remove SATA cable from Hard disk drive assembly Refer Figure 8-51 on page 8-47 Power cable Sata Signal Cable Figure 8-51 Removing SATA cable 8-4-11-5 Mounting procedure Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-4-11-6 Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional Test Debrief Script 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-4-11. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-47 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 8-5 USB Cable Set (FRU P/N: 5315039) 8-5-0-1 Tools • 8-5-0-2 Needed Manpower • 8-5-0-3 1 persons, 15 minutes per cable Preparations • 8-5-0-4 Common Phillips screwdrivers Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal Procedure 1. Remove the covers and parts as applicable. Refer to the applicable section of this document. 2. Unplug the USB cable from both the ends and remove the cable from the machine. 8-5-0-5 8-48 Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional Test Debrief Script 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up Proprietary Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-5. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown Section 8-5 - USB Cable Set (FRU P/N: 5315039) GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 8-5-1 LV and Power distribution Board (Part No: 5315028) / Power distribution Board Assembly (Part no :5315104) - LOGIQ P3 8-5-1-1 Tools • 8-5-1-2 Needed Manpower • 8-5-1-3 Common Phillips screwdrivers 1person, 15 minutes Preparations Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system 8-5-1-4 Removal Procedure 1) Loosen the Two screw (A) and pull out the Cables which are connected to PDB as shown in rectangle box (B) in the Figure 8-50 on page 8-46 2) Remove LV & PDB assembly.Refer Figure 8-50 on page 8-46 (B) Power cables (A) Two Screws (B) Power cable Figure 8-52 Removing Hard Disk Drive Power cable Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-49 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 3) Remove SATA cable from Hard disk drive assembly Refer Figure 8-51 on page 8-47 PDB Bracket Figure 8-53 Removing SATA cable 8-5-1-5 Mounting procedure Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-5-1-6 8-50 Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional Test Debrief Script 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-5-1. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown Section 8-5 - USB Cable Set (FRU P/N: 5315039) GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 8-5-2 Power distribution Board Assembly (P/N: 5370455), PDB Sub (P/N: 5370323), PDB Sub (Part no.: 5397797) - LOGIQ P3BT10 8-5-2-1 Tools • 8-5-2-2 Needed Manpower • 8-5-2-3 Common Phillips screwdrivers 1person, 15 minutes Preparations Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system 8-5-2-4 Removal Procedure 1) Loosen the two screws (A) and pull out the Cables which are connected to PDB as shown in rectangle box (B) in the figure. 2) Remove PDB assembly. (B) Power cables (A) Two Screws (B) Power cable Figure 8-54 Removing Hard Disk Drive Power cable Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-51 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 3) Remove SATA cable from Hard disk drive assembly Refer Figure 8-51 on page 8-47 Figure 8-55 Removing Power Distribution Board 8-5-2-5 Mounting procedure Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-5-2-6 8-52 Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional Test Debrief Script 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-5-1. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown Section 8-5 - USB Cable Set (FRU P/N: 5315039) GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-5-3 8-5-3-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL FAN Assy (FRU No.: 5314414) Tools Common Philips screwdrivers 8-5-3-2 Needed Manpower 1 person, 15 minutes 8-5-3-3 Preparations Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. 8-5-3-4 Removal Procedure To remove MST side FAN Remove the side cover. Refer section 8-4-2 on page 26 to remove the LH-side cover. Refer Figure 839 on page 8-39 to remove the EMI cover and then MST. Figure 8-56 MST side FAN 8-5-3-5 Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional Test Debrief Script 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-6-1. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-53 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-5-4 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Rear Panel Assy (110V FRU P/N: 5315503/ 220V FRU P/N: 5315504) - LOGIQ P3 Rear Panel Assy (FRU No. 5368251) - LOGIQ P3BT10 This is a description on how to remove and replace the Rear Panel Assy. 8-5-4-1 Tools • 8-5-4-2 Common Phillips screwdrivers Needed Manpower 1 persons, 15 minutes 8-5-4-3 Preparations • 8-5-4-4 Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal Procedure 1) Remove the rear cover . Refer Refer section 8-4-3 on page 27 2) Loosen the Five screws (1,2,3,4) of rear panel assembly of the system. Refer Figure 8-57 on page 8-54 Figure 8-57 Rear pannel Assembly 3) Push upwards & Pull out the Rear panel assembly by the slot marked (A,) in the Figure 8-58 on page 8-55 8-54 Section 8-5 - USB Cable Set (FRU P/N: 5315039) GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 4) Remove Rear panel assembly from the system Slide upwards as shown below Figure 8-58 on page 8-55 A Figure 8-58 Removing Rear panel assembly 5) LOGIQ P3 - Disconnect the FRC cable, Power cable & USB Cables from rear pannel assembly. Refer Figure 8-59 on page 8-55 Figure 8-59 Removing FRC & USB cables 8-5-4-5 Mounting procedure 1.) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-55 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-5-4-6 8-56 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional Test Debrief Script 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-6-1. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown Section 8-5 - USB Cable Set (FRU P/N: 5315039) GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 8-5-5 Connector Board Assy 3PP (FRU No. 5314411) / Connector Board Assy 2PP (FRUNo. 5314412) This is a description on how to remove and replace the Conn. Board Assy. 8-5-5-1 Tools • 8-5-5-2 Needed Manpower • 8-5-5-3 1 person, 15 minutes Preparations • 8-5-5-4 Common Phillips screwdrivers Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal Procedure NOTE: CAUTION An Electronic discharge may damage a component.turn OFF power and wear the wrist strap before you remove circuit boards. do not un plug the power card to keep ground continuity. do not bend or flex the boards when mounting /dismounting each boards surface mount IC boards are very susceptible to damage from flex/torque. 1) Remove Right cover , Refer Refer section 8-4-1 on page 24 for details on how to remove right cover 2) Remove Left cover , Refer Refer section 8-4-2 on page 26 for details on how to remove right cover 3) Remove Front cover , Refer Refer section Figure 8-28 on page 29 for details on how to remove right cover 4) Loosen Four Screws to remove the connector board and remove the conn board from the system.Refer .Figure 8-60 on page 8-57 .To open the Hinge Door Loosen knob screw(a) & (B) Figure 8-60 Connector Board assembly Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-57 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Figure 8-61 Removeing Conn board assembly 5) Remove the conn board TX cable and PDB conn board cable (or power cable). Refer Figure 8-62 on page 8-58 Power cable Conn board Tx cable Figure 8-62 Removing Power cable & Conn board Tx cable 8-58 Section 8-5 - USB Cable Set (FRU P/N: 5315039) GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 6) Loosen two screws (a,b) of flexi cable from conn board to Tx board. Refer Figure 8-63 on page 8-59 Figure 8-63 Loosen screws of flexi cable 7) Remove flexi cable from conn board to Tx board. Refer Figure 8-64 on page 8-59 Figure 8-64 Removing Flexi cable conn board 8) Use the screwdriver & remove four screws (1, 2, 3, 4) of connector board from the system. Refer Figure 8-60 on page 8-57 9) Slide the connector board out. 8-5-5-5 Mounting procedure 1.) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-59 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-5-5-6 8-60 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional Test 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown 4-3-6 B Mode Checks 4-3-7 M Mode Controls 4-3-8 Color Flow Mode Checks 4-3-9 Doppler Mode Checks Debrief Script Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-6-2. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. Section 8-5 - USB Cable Set (FRU P/N: 5315039) GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-5-6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL TX Board (FRU No. 2404903)/ Flex Cable (Con to Tx) Assy (FRU No.5315108) This is a description on how to remove and replace the TX Board or Flex cable. 8-5-6-1 Tools • 8-5-6-2 Needed Manpower • 8-5-6-3 1 person, 30 minutes Preparations • 8-5-6-4 Common Phillips screwdrivers Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal Procedure 1) Remove the connector board assembly.Refer Refer section 8-5-5 on page 57 2) Loosen the Five screws (1,2,3,4,5,) of TX board from the system. Refer Figure 8-65 on page 8-61 3) Remove the Tx board from the system.Refer Figure 8-65 on page 8-61 1 2 4 3 5 Figure 8-65 TX board Assembly 3) Pull the Tx board from the system as shown below 4) Remove the Tx conn board cable, as shown in figure below Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-61 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 5) Remove the two flexi cable from TX board as shown below Tx conn board cable Flexi cable 6) To Remove the Flexi cable remove one side fron connector board & other side on TX PWA. 7) To remove the TX, remove the 7 fasteners holding TX to RX as shown in Figure 8-68 on page 8-64 8-5-6-5 Mounting procedure 1.) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-5-6-6 8-62 Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional Test 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown 4-3-6 B Mode Checks 4-3-7 M Mode Controls 4-3-8 Color Flow Mode Checks 4-3-9 Doppler Mode Checks Debrief Script Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-6-3. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. Section 8-5 - USB Cable Set (FRU P/N: 5315039) GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 8-6 RX Board (FRU P/N: 5315027) 8-6-0-1 Tools • 8-6-0-2 Needed Manpower • 8-6-0-3 1 person, 30 minutes Preparations • 8-6-0-4 Common Phillips screwdrivers Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal Procedure 1) Remove the connector board assembly. Refer section 8-5-5 on page 57 2) Loosen the Five screws (1,2,3,4,5,) of TX board from the system. Refer Figure 8-65 on page 8-61 3) Remove the Tx board from the system. Refer Figure 8-65 on page 8-61 1 2 4 3 5 Figure 8-66 TX board Assembly 4) Remove the Tx conn board cable, Refer Figure 8-67 on page 8-64 Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-63 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 5) Remove the two flexi cable from TX board as shown below in Figure 8-67 on page 8-64 Tx conn board cable Flexi cable Figure 8-67 Removing TX conn board cable & Flexi cable 6) Remove the Screws fixed in Tx Pwa & seperate the RX PWA from TX PWA as shown in Figure 8-68 on page 8-64 Figure 8-68 Tx-RX combined 8-6-0-5 Mounting procedure 1.) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-64 Section 8-6 - RX Board (FRU P/N: 5315027) GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-6-0-6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional Test 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown 4-3-6 B Mode Checks 4-3-7 M Mode Controls 4-3-8 Color Flow Mode Checks 4-3-9 Doppler Mode Checks Debrief Script Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-7-0. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-65 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-6-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Flexi Cable (MST to TX) Assy (FRU No.5315109) This is a description on how to remove and replace the TX Board or Flex cable. 8-6-1-1 Tools • 8-6-1-2 Needed Manpower • 8-6-1-3 1 person, 30 minutes Preparations • 8-6-1-4 Common Phillips screwdrivers Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal Procedure 1) Remove the connector board assembly. Refer section 8-5-5 on page 57 2) Loosen the Five screws (1,2,3,4,5,) of TX board from the system. Refer Figure 8-65 on page 8-61 3) Remove the Tx board from the system. Refer Figure 8-65 on page 8-61 1 2 4 3 5 Figure 8-69 TX board Assembly 3) Pull the Tx board from the system.as shown below Figure 8-66 on page 8-63 4) Remove the Tx conn board cable. Refer Figure 8-67 on page 8-64 8-66 Section 8-6 - RX Board (FRU P/N: 5315027) GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 5) Remove the two flexi cable from TX board as shown below in Figure 8-70 on page 8-67 Tx conn board cable Flexi cable Figure 8-70 Removing TX conn board cable & Flexi cable 6) To Remove the Fex cable remove one side fron connector board & other side on TX PWA. 7) Use screwdriver to remove the screws of MST to TX flexi cable and remove the core. Refer Figure 8-71 on page 8-67 Figure 8-71 Removing Flexi cable of MST board 8-6-1-5 Mounting procedure 1.) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-67 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-6-1-6 NOTE: 8-68 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional Test 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown 4-3-6 B Mode Checks 4-3-7 M Mode Controls 4-3-8 Color Flow Mode Checks 4-3-9 Doppler Mode Checks Debrief Script Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-7-1. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. LOGIQ P3 BT10 - For the circuit breaker, there is 4 amps FUSE, 2 no.s FUSE for each neutral and line. Section 8-6 - RX Board (FRU P/N: 5315027) GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 8-7 Power Block - LOGIQ P3 8-7-1 Transformer Assembly (FRU No. 5196448) Cable Guard Clamp (FRU No:5219747) This is a description on how to remove and replace the Transformer Assy. 8-7-1-1 Tools • 8-7-1-2 Needed Manpower • 8-7-1-3 Common Phillips screwdrivers 1 persons, 15 minutes Preparations • Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. NOTE: For 110V System Configuration use 110V wired Plug (with 3 Amps Fuse). NOTE: For 230V System Configuration use 230V Wired plug (With 2 Amps Fuse). NOTE: To replace Cable Guard Clamp Donot remove the transformer,remove power cord and press the cable clamp from both the sides the clamp will come out side. 8-7-1-4 Removal Procedure 1) Remove rear cover. Refer section 8-4-3 on page 27 2) Unscrew two screws (a,b) as marked in Figure 8-72 on page 8-69 3) Remove GND cable (which ever connected near to “a” ). Refer Figure 8-72 on page 8-69 GND cable a b Figure 8-72 Removing Transformer Assembly Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-69 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 4) Pull out the transformer tray assembly from the system. Refer Figure 8-73 on page 8-70 Figure 8-73 Removing Tansformer Assembly 5) Pull out the transformer tray so the connector marked J4 is accessible and disconnect cable. Refer Figure 8-74 on page 8-70 Figure 8-74 Removing Transformer cable 8-70 Section 8-7 - Power Block - LOGIQ P3 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-7-1-5 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Mounting procedure 1.) Install the transformer assy in the reverse order of removal. 8-7-1-6 Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional and/or Leakage Current Test 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown 10-7-5 Chassis Leakage Current Test Debrief Script Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-8-1. Leakage Current measured at {---------------}. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use.. Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-71 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 8-7-2 Power Block - LOGIQ P3 BT10 8-7-3 Power Entry Module (FRU No: 5397502) Cable Guard (FRU No: 5389807) This is a description on how to remove and replace the Transformer Assy. 8-7-3-1 Tools • 8-7-3-2 Needed Manpower • 8-7-3-3 1 persons, 15 minutes Preparations • 8-7-3-4 Common Phillips screwdrivers Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal Procedure 1) Remove rear cover. Refer section 8-4-3 on page 27. To remove the rear cover, remove the side covers. 2) Unscrew two screws (a,b) as marked in Figure 8-72 on page 8-69 3) Remove GND cable (which ever connected near to “a” ). Refer Figure 8-72 on page 8-69 GND cable Figure 8-75 Removing Transformer Assembly 8-72 Section 8-7 - Power Block - LOGIQ P3 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 4) Pull out the transformer tray assembly from the system. Refer Figure 8-73 on page 8-70 Figure 8-76 Removing Tansformer Assembly 8-7-3-5 Mounting procedure Install the transformer assy in the reverse order of removal. 8-7-3-6 Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional and/or Leakage Current Test 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up 4-3-2 Debrief Script Power Off/ Shutdown Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-8-1. Leakage Current measured at {---------------}. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use.. 10-7-5 Chassis Leakage Current Test Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-73 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 8-8Key Caps (FRU P/N: 5315124) 8-8-0-1 Tools • 8-8-0-2 Needed Manpower • 8-8-0-3 1person, 15 minutes Preparations • 8-8-0-4 Common Phillips screwdrivers Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal Procedure 1) Remove the Keyboard assembly. Refer section 4-2-1. 2) Remove 24 screws shown in figure below and seperate the Keyboard PWA. Remove the 24 screws. 3) Push the key cap out from the rear side and remove it. Key Caps Figure 8-77 Top View of Key Caps 8-74 Section 8-8 - Key Caps (FRU P/N: 5315124) GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-8-0-5 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Mounting procedure 1.) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-8-0-6 Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional Test Debrief Script 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-9-0. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-75 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 8-9DVD Drive 8-9-1 DVD Tray Assembly (FRU P/N: ) / DVD Drive ( FRU P/N: 5312274) This is a description on how to remove and replace the CD Tray Assembly. 8-9-1-1 Tools • 8-9-1-2 Needed Manpower • 8-9-1-3 Common phillips screwdrivers 1person, 15 minutes Preparations Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. 8-9-1-4 Removal Procedure 1) Loosen two screws and Remove the DVD tray assembly. Refer Figure 8-78 on page 8-76 2) Disconnect the cables connected to the DVD drive. 3) Remove the DVD drive from the DVD tary by removing the four screws holding it. Refer Figure 8-78 on page 8-76 Figure 8-78 Removal CD drive Assembly 8-9-1-5 Mounting procedure 1.) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-9-1-6 8-76 Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional Test Debrief Script 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-10-1. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown Section 8-9 - DVD Drive GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 8-10 Power Cable 8-10-0-1 Tools • None Part Number Description 5337332 5248395 5248396 5248393 5248394 5390874 5398510 5182816 5182940 5182083 5182235 Power Cord India Power Cord China Power cable Europe Power cable Japan Power cable America Power cable Brazil Power cable Israel Power Cord UK/HK Power Cord Italy Power Cord Denmark Power Cord Switzerland 8-10-0-2 Needed Manpower • 8-10-0-3 Preparations • 8-10-0-4 1person, 15 minutes Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal Procedure 1. Pull the metal clamp upwards. 2. Remove the power cable as shown in the Figure below. Figure 8-79 Power Cable 8-10-0-5 Mounting procedure 1.) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-77 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-10-0-6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional Test 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up 4-3-2 Debrief Script Power Off/ Shutdown Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-11-0. Leakage Current measured at {---------------}. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use.. 10-7-5 8-78 Chassis Leakage Current Test Section 8-10 - Power Cable GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 8-11 Video Interface Board 8-11-0-1 Tools Common Philips screwdrivers 8-11-0-2 FRU BOM This FRU part comes along with the two screws 8-11-0-3 Needed Manpower 1 person, 8-11-0-4 Preparation Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom of the rear side of the system. 8-11-0-5 Removal Procedure Remove the left side cover (Refer 8-4-2 on page 8-26 ) and remove the EMI cover (Refer 8-4-9 on page 8-39 ). In the Video Interface Board, unscrew the two screws and remove all the cables connected to that board. 8-11-0-6 Mounting Procedure Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal. 8-11-0-7 Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional Test Debrief Script 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-2-3. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. Figure 8-80 Video Interface Board Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-79 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 8-12 Signal Cable Set (FRU P/N: 5315042) 8-12-0-1 Tools • 8-12-0-2 Common Phillips screwdrivers FRU BOM This FRU Kit P/N: 5315042 consists of following parts. Note:This individual cables are not seperate FRUs, but are part of cable kit higher level FRU Table 8-1 LOGIQ P3 Part Numbers Description 5272230 5265925 5262402 5273129 5266424 5272618 5269755 5268980 5264458 5267353 Real panel Interface cable assembly LCD signal Cable Docking Brd to Speaker SATA signal Cable for HDD Keyboard ground Cable Fan Cable Assembly TGC Interface Cable Track ball 4 pin interface Track ball 6 pin interface Encoder PCB 15 pin interface Table 8-2 LOGIQ P3 BT10 Part Numbers Description 5265925 5262402 5273129 5266424 5269755 5268980 5264458 5267353 5342787 5342788 5342786 LCD signal Cable Docking Brd to Speaker SATA signal Cable for HDD Keyboard ground Cable TGC Interface Cable Track ball 4 pin interface Track ball 6 pin interface Encoder PCB 15 pin interface VGA cable assembly Video Interface to MST board Cable assembly Ethernet Cable assembly 8-12-0-3 Needed Manpower • 8-12-0-4 Preparations • 8-12-0-5 1 persons, 15 minutes per cable Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal Procedure 1. Remove the covers and parts as applicable. Refer to the applicable section of this document. 2. Unplug the signal cable from both the ends. 8-80 Section 8-12 - Signal Cable Set (FRU P/N: 5315042) GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-12-0-6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional Test Debrief Script 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-12-0. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-81 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 8-13 Power Cable Set (FRU P/N: 5315036) 8-13-0-1 Tools • 8-13-0-2 Common Phillips screwdrivers FRU BOM This FRU Kit P/N:5315036 consists of following parts. Note: This individual cables are not seperate FRUs, but are part of cable kit higher level FRU. Table 8-3 LOGIQ P3 Part Number Description 5270783 5262720 5262046 5269059 5269791 5269919 5270870 5269067 5263747 5263844 Cable Assembly for Transformer to PS, SSR and Peripheral Connector Cable Assembly for Panel mount connector to power supply & solid state relay Peripheral Connector to Rear panel sockets PDB to Conn Brd and MST Brd LCD Power cable Dual SATA Power Cable for PDB to HDD and DVD PDB to KBD and Fan Conn Brd to TXB Docking Brd to RP2 FRC cable MST to KBD & DVD SATA Signal cable Table 8-4 LOGIQ P3 BT10 Part Number Description 5342775 5342780 5342888 5366298 5269919 5270870 5269067 5263844 5342783 5390435 5342782 Cable Assembly: 1 Power entry to PS, Relay and Printer Power Assembly to Power supply and Relay Card_Cable assembly PDB to Conn Brd, MST Brd and RP2 BRD_Cable Assembly LCD DC Power cable Dual SATA Power Cable for PDB to HDD and DVD PDB to KBD and Fan Conn Brd to TXB MST to KBD & DVD SATA Signal cable Power Supply output to PDB POWER_SUPPLY_FAN_CABLE_ASSEMBLY Cable assembly: 4 PDB to SBV board 8-13-0-3 Needed Manpower • 8-13-0-4 Preparations • 8-13-0-5 1 persons, 15 minutes per cable Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Removal Procedure 1. Remove the covers and parts as applicable. Refer to the applicable section of this document. 2. Unplug the power cable from both the ends. 8-82 Section 8-13 - Power Cable Set (FRU P/N: 5315036) GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-13-0-6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional Test Debrief Script 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Rev 2, Section 8-13-0. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-83 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-13-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL CWD Assy (FRU No: 5315026 ) Purpose: This is a description on how to remove and replace the CWD Assy. 8-13-1-1 8-13-1-2 Tools • Common phillips screwdrivers • Allen/Unbraco wrench Needed Manpower • 8-13-1-3 1 person, 30 minutes + travel Preparations • Shutdown the system and switch off the main Circuit Breaker at the bottom rear side of the system. Figure 8-81 Removal Procedure of cwd Refer to 8-13-1 on page 8-84 . 1.) Unscrew two screws(1-2). 2.) Disconnect the CWD assy. 8-13-1-4 Removal procedure Refer to 8-13-1 on page 8-84 . 1.) Unscrew two screws (1-2) to remove the CWD cover. see 8-13-1 on page 8-84 ] 2.) Connect the CWD assy to RX64. [See 8-13-1 on page 8-84 ] 3.) Press the CWD assy tightenedly, refer to 8-13-1 on page 8-84 . 4.) Screw two screws (1-2) to fix the CWD assy on RX64 assy., see 8-13-1 on page 8-84 ] 8-84 Section 8-13 - Power Cable Set (FRU P/N: 5315036) GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-13-1-5 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional Test 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown 4-3-6 B Mode Checks 4-3-7 M Mode Controls 4-3-8 Color Flow Mode Checks 4-3-9 Doppler Mode Checks Debrief Script Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-13-15. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-85 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 8-14 Loading Base Image Software LOGIQ P3 - FRU part num for Base Image software. 1.) 5308912-3 Logiq P3 Application Software with Base Image for Expert. 2.) 5315328-3 Logiq P3 Application Software with Base Image for BW. 3.) 5315327-3 Logiq P3 Application Software with Base Image for Pro. LOGIQ P3 BT10 - FRU part num for Base Image software. 1.) 5308912-2 Logiq P3 Application Software with Base Image for Expert. 2.) 5315328-2 Logiq P3 Application Software with Base Image for BW. 3.) 5315327-2 Logiq P3 Application Software with Base Image for Pro. NOTE: While it is believed to be unnecessary, It would not hurt to disconnect the system from the network and remove all transducers. NOTE: To Enter BIOS Press F2 (Arrow) Key immediately after power on and enter BIOS Password for LP3 as lakshya. NOTE: Please ensure AC adapter is connected during system upgrade! 1.) Before loading the Software Backup the database for reference see 4-3-14-2 on page 4-28 and after loading the Software Restore the bacup database. 2.) Insert the disk labeled “System & Application Software” into the DVD drive. 3.) Properly turn off the scanner by momentarily pressing the Power On/Off Switch. Select “Shutdown” from the System Exit menu. 4.) If the system will not shutdown normally, hold down the Power On/Off Switch until the light turns from green to amber. Figure 8-82 Shutdown Dialog Box 5.) Turn on the scanner. System will detect the DVD-RW automatically. 8-86 Section 8-14 - Loading Base Image Software GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 6.) Press any key to continue when below message display as shown in Figure 8-83 on page 8-87 . Figure 8-83 Update message 7.) Select one of the options for loading the system. Select choice [a] to load the complete disk. Refer to Figure 8-84 on page 8-87 . Figure 8-84 Selection for loading the system WARNING While the software install procedure is designed to preserve data, you should select choice [b] to format disk C only. 8.) Press “Yes” or “No” to continue. Figure 8-85 Confirmation on loading the system Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-87 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 9.) System DVD will be loaded as shown in Figure 8-86 10.).Once the software is completely loaded, a message will be displayed as shown in Figure 8-87. Figure 8-86 System CD loading Figure 8-87 System upgrade complete 11.) Remove the DVD from the system and reboot. Enter the system serial number and option key. 8-88 Section 8-14 - Loading Base Image Software GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-14-0-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Initiate Software reload from the Common Service Desktop Figure 8-88 Windows start 1.) Log on to the Common Service Desktop as GE Service. It requires the rotating security password. 2.) Select Utilities. 3.) Select Invoke SW Reload. This brings up the dialog as shown in the below figure. Figure 8-89 Invoke SW Reload 4.) Call the Online Center (OLC). Tell the OLC that you need a “Challenge Code”, and on request, you must read the challenge string on the screen. OLC will return a password that you need to type in as the Response. 5.) Enter the Response (password) you received from OLC. From the repository, the System Software reloading starts. The “Reload system setup successful. Reboot system to begin SW reload” screen appears. 6.) Reboot the system either manually or through “System Shutdown” under Common Utilities. Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-89 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 8-14-0-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Initiate software reload from the Recovery Console Ensure that the LOGIQ P3 is powered down. 1.) Press the power on button on the keyboard. The LOGIQ P3 starts. 2.) Press the Esc button on the alphanumeric keyboard multiple times until the GE screen appears. Then continuously press the Esc button until the blue color progress bar is seen on the screen as shown below. Figure 8-90 GE screen with progress bar 3.) The GRUB menu screen appears. On the GRUB menu, select Recovery Console. The GE Healthcare Recovery Console is displayed. Enter the password. Figure 8-91 GRUB menu 8-90 Section 8-14 - Loading Base Image Software GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL 4.) Call the Online Center (OLC). Tell the OLC that you need a “Challenge Code”, and on request, you must read the challenge string on the screen. OLC will return a password that you need to type in as the Response. 5.) Enter the Response (password) you received from OLC. The System Software loading from the repository starts. After the Software loading is complete, restore the Backed up Database. 8-14-0-3 8-14-1 Functional Checkout Procedure See Section Functional Test 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown 4-3-6 B Mode Checks 4-3-7 M Mode Controls 4-3-8 Color Flow Mode Checks 4-3-9 Doppler Mode Checks Debrief Script Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-14-0. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. For a service call with no fru replacement, use the following debrief script. See Section Functional Test 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up 4-3-2 Power Off/ Shutdown 4-3-6 B Mode Checks 4-3-7 M Mode Controls 4-3-8 Color Flow Mode Checks 4-3-9 Doppler Mode Checks Debrief Script Service Manual Direction 5308917-100, Section 8-14-1. Equipment passes all required tests and is ready for use. Chapter 8 Replacement Procedures 8-91 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL This page was intentionally left blank. 8-92 Section 8-14 - Loading Base Image Software GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Chapter 9 Renewal Parts Section 9-1 Overview 9-1-1 Purpose of Chapter 9 This chapter gives you an overview of Spare Parts available for the LOGIQ P3. Table 9-1 Contents in Chapter 9 Section Description Page Number 9-1 Overview 9-1 9-2 List of Abbreviations 9-2 9-3 Operator Console Assy 9-3 9-4 LCD Assy 9-4 9-5 Keyboard Assy 9-5 9-6 Mechanical Assy 9-8 9-7 Pwa Assy 9-11 9-8 Flex PCB Cables 9-13 9-9 Signal Cable Set 9-14 9-10 USB Cable set 9-16 9-11 Power Cable Set 9-17 9-12 Accessories and Kits 9-19 9-13 Probe 9-21 9-14 Logiq P3 FRU List With Part Numbers 9-22 Chapter 9 Renewal Parts 9-1 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 9-2 List of Abbreviations • • • • • • • • • • 9-2 Assy - Assembly Ctrl - Control FRU 1 - Replacement part available in part hub KBD - Keyboard LCD - Liquid Crystal Display BnV - Brightness and Volume RX64- Front Processor Board TMST - Master Board TX64 - Transmit Board PDB- Power Distribution Board Section 9-2 - List of Abbreviations GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 9-3 Operator Console Assy Figure 9-1 OPERATOR CONSOLE ASSY 1.) Peripheral Device (Signals I/O Port, Power In) 2.) Three Probe Port 3.) ECG 4.) DVD-RW Drive 5.) Monitor 6.) USB Port 7.) B/W Printer Option 8.) Probe Holder 9.) Gel Holder 10.) VGA Connector 11.) Ethernet Connector 12.) S Video Connector 13.) BNC Connector 14.) USB Ports 15.) Circuit Breaker 16.) Power connector Chapter 9 Renewal Parts 9-3 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 9-4 LCD Assy 100 Figure 9-2 LCD Assy Table 9-2 LCD Assy Item Part Name Description 5311512 (LP3) 1 100 LCDMON II 5396925 (LP3 BT10) 9-4 Quantity Section 9-4 - LCD Assy 1 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 9-5 Keyboard Assy 200 202 203 204 201 205 Figure 9-3 Keyboard Assy Chapter 9 Renewal Parts 9-5 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 Section 9-5 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Keyboard Assy (cont’d) Table 9-3 Keyboard Assy Item Part Name Part Number Description Quantity 200 Keyboard Assy 5314404 Keyboard Assy 1 201 A/N Keyboard Assy 5315106 A/N Key Assy 1 202 TGC Assy 5315107 TGC 1 203 TB Assy 5315029 TB Assy 1 204 NTPUI Encoder PWA Asm 5316731 NTPUI Encoder PWA Asm 1 205 Knob set 5315502 TGC knob, Gain knob 1 each 9-5-1 Keyboard key caps FRU part no:- 5315124 Figure 9-4 Table 9-4 Item 9-6 Keyboard Key caps Part Number Description Quantity 301 5310049 Patient_Key_Lakshya 1 302 5310050 Power_Key_Lakshya 1 303 5310051 Probe_Key_Lakshya 1 304 5310052 Report_Key_Lakshya 1 305 5310053 End_Exam_Key_Lakshya 1 306 5310054 Menu_Key_Lakshya 1 307 5310055 M_Key_Lakshya 1 308 5310056 CW_Key_Lakshya 1 Section 9-5 - Keyboard Assy GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 Item PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Part Number Description Quantity 309 5310057 PW_Key_Lakshya 1 310 5310059 PDI_Key_Lakshya 1 311 5310060 CF_Key_Lakshya 1 312 5310061 Active_Key_Lakshya 1 313 5310062 Select_Key_Lakshya 1 314 5310063 Clear_Key_Lakshya 1 315 5310064 Comment_Key_Lakshya 1 316 5310065 Measure_Key_Lakshya 1 317 5310066 Cursor_Key_Lakshya 1 318 5310067 Scan_Area_Key_Lakshya 1 319 5310068 Set_Key_Lakshya 1 320 5310069 Auto_Key_Lakshya 1 321 5310070 Harmonic_Key_Lakshya 1 322 5310071 LH_Key_Lakshya 1 323 5310072 RH_Key_Lakshya 1 324 5310073 Reverse_Key_Lakshya 1 325 5310074 User1_Key_Lakhsya 1 326 5310075 User2_Key_Lakshya 1 327 5310076 P4_Key_Lakshya 1 328 5310077 P3_Key_Lakshya 1 329 5310078 P2_Key_Lakshya 1 330 5310079 P1_Key_Lakshya 1 331 5310080 Freeze_Key_Lakshya 1 Chapter 9 Renewal Parts 9-7 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 9-6Mechanical Assy 401 402 403 405 404 406 407 Figure 9-5 Mech Assy 9-8 Section 9-6 - Mechanical Assy GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 Section 9-6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Mechanical Assy (cont’d) 408 409 410 411 412 413 414 Figure 9-6 Mech Assy Chapter 9 Renewal Parts 9-9 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Table 9-5 Mech assembly Item Part Name Part Number Description Quantity 401 ARM Cover 5310093 ARM Cover 1 402 Keyboard Rear cover Assy 5315122 Keyboard Rear cover Assy 1 403 Right cover (A) & Left cover (B) 5315114 & 5315115 Right cover (A) & Left cover (B) 1 404 Top Cover Assy 5315121 Top Cover 1 405 Probe & Gelbottle holder 5313573 Probe & Gelbottle holder 1 406 Rear cover 5315117 Rear cover 1 407 Front cover 5315116 Front cover 1 408 Rear EMI Cover 5315111 EMI Cover Set 1 409 RPA 230V & RPA 100V (P3) 5313708 Rear Panel ASSY -100V / 220V 1 410 Rear Panel (P3 BT10) 5368251 Rear Panel Assy 1 411 Handle 5315120 Handle 1 412 3 port Conu board EMI cover 5314411 3 port Conu board EMI cover 1 413 LH Emi cover 5315111 EMI Cover Set 1 414 RH emi cover 5315111 EMI Cover Set 1 9-10 Section 9-6 - Mechanical Assy GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 9-7Pwa Assy 501 502 503 Figure 9-7 PWA Assy Chapter 9 Renewal Parts 9-11 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 9-7-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Pwa assy (cont’d) 504 506 505 508 509 510 Figure 9-8 Pwa assy 9-12 Section 9-7 - Pwa Assy 507 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Compatibility Item Part Name Part Number Description P3 R1.x.x P3 BT10 R2.x.x Qty 501 CWD 5124847 CWD Yes Yes 1 502 Connector Board 2PP Asm 5314412 Connector Board 2PP Asm Yes Yes 1 503 Sata Hard disk Assy 5315113 SATA HArd Disk Assy (160GB) Yes Yes 1 504 MST 5315025 MST Yes No 1 505 MST 5388844 MST No Yes 1 506 RX PWA 5315027 RX PWa ASM with Bracket Yes Yes 1 507 TX PWA 2404903 TX PWA Yes Yes 1 508 LV & PDB power supply 5315028 LV & Power Distribution Board assy Yes No 1 509 PDB Power supply 5370455 Power Distribution Board assy No Yes 1 PDB Sub1 5370323 Collector part No Yes 1 PDB Sub2 5397797 Collector part No Yes 1 Video Interface Board 5397507 Video Interface Board No Yes 1 510 Section 9-8 Flex PCB Cables 601 602 Figure 9-9 Cable Assy Item Part NUm Description Quantity 601 5315108 Flex Cable (Con to Tx) 1 602 5315109 Flex Cable (MST to TX) 1 Chapter 9 Renewal Parts 9-13 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 9-9 Signal Cable Set 701 704 707 702 703 706 705 708 709 710 711 Figure 9-10 9-14 Section 9-9 - Signal Cable Set GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 Table 9-5 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Signal Cable Set Compatibility Item Part Name Part Number Description P3 R1.x.x P3 BT10 R2.x.x Qty 701 LCD signal Cable 5265925 LCD signal Cable Yes Yes 1 702 Docking Brd to Speaker 5262402 Docking Board to Speaker Yes Yes 1 703 SATA signal Cable 5273129 SATA signal Cable Yes Yes 1 704 Keyboard Ground Cable 5266424 Keyboard Ground Cable Yes Yes 1 705 TGC Interface Cable 5269755 TGC Interface Cable Yes Yes 1 706 Track ball 4 pin interface 5268980 Track ball 4 pin interface Yes Yes 1 707 Track ball 6 pin interface 5264458 Track ball 6 pin interface Yes Yes 1 708 Encoder PCB 15 pin interface 5267353 Encoder PCB 15 pin interface Yes Yes 1 709 VGA cable assembly 5342787 VGA cable assembly No Yes 1 No Yes 1 No Yes 1 Video Interface to MST board Cable 710 Video Interface to MST board 5342788 assembly 711 Ethernet Cable assembly 5342786 Cable assembly Ethernet Cable assembly Chapter 9 Renewal Parts 9-15 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 9-10 USB Cable set 802 803 801 Figure 9-11 Table 9-6 USB Cable Set Item Part Name Part Number Description Quantity 801 USB cable 5315039 USB Cable 1 9-16 Section 9-10 - USB Cable set GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 9-11 Power Cable Set 901 902 903 905 904 907 910 908 911 906 909 912 Figure 9-12 Chapter 9 Renewal Parts 9-17 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 Table 9-7 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Power Cable Set Compatibility P3 R1.x.x P3 BT10 R2.x.x Qty No Yes 1 No Yes 1 Item Part Name Part Number 901 Cable Assembly 5342775 902 PDB to Conn Brd 5342888 903 LCD DC Power cable 5366298 LCD DC Power cable Yes No 1 904 Dual SATA Power Cable 5269919 Dual SATA Power Cable Yes Yes 1 905 PDB to KBD and Fan 5270870 PDB to KBD and Fan Yes Yes 1 906 Conn Brd to TXB 5269067 Connector Board to TX Board Yes Yes 1 Yes Yes 1 MST to KBD & DVD SATA Signal 907 Description Cable Assembly: 1 Power entry to PS, Relay and Printer PDB to Conn Board, MST Board and RP2 BRD_Cable Assembly MST to KBD & DVD SATA Signal 5263844 cable cable 908 Power Supply output to PDB 5342783 Power Supply output to PDB No Yes 1 909 Power Supply Fan Cable Assembly 5390435 Power Supply Fan Cable Assembly No Yes 1 910 Cable assembly: 4 PDB to SBV board 5342782 Cable assembly: 4 PDB to SBV board No Yes 1 911 LCD DC Power cable 5269791 LCD DC Power cable Yes No 1 912 PDB to Conn Brd 5269059 PDB to Conn Board, MST Board Yes No 1 9-18 Section 9-11 - Power Cable Set GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 9-12 Accessories and Kits Table 9-8 Accessories and Kits (LOGIQ P3) Item Part Name Part Number Description Quantity 1001 USB Footswitch 5151236 3 Pedal Footswitch 1 1002 Digital B/W Printer Thermal Printer 5160406 B/W Printer 1 1003 Color USB Thermal Printer- (Option) 5310886 Option part 1 1004 USB thumb Drive- (Option) 5308966 Option part 1 1005 LOGIQ P3 Application Software with Base ImageDVD 5308912-1 LOGIQ P3 Application Software with Base ImageDVD (R1.0.1) 1 1006 LOGIQ P3 Pro Application Software with Base ImageDVD 5315327-1 LOGIQ P3 Pro Application Software with Base ImageDVD (R1.0.1) 1 1007 LOGIQ P3 B/W Application Software with Base ImageDVD 5315328-1 LOGIQ P3 B/W Application Software with Base Image (R1.0.1) 1 1008 USB Hard Disk (160GB) - (Option) 5313598 USB Hard Disk (160GB) - (Option) 1 1009 DeskJet Printer- (Option) 5309104 Option part 1 1010 ECG Module 5262765 Option Part 1 1011 Power Cord India 2365882 Power Cord India 1 1012 Power Cord China 5248395 Power Cord China 1 1013 POWER CABLE Europe 5248396 POWER CABLE Europe 1 1014 POWER CABLE Japan 5248393 POWER CABLE Japan 1 1015 POWER CABLE America 5248394 POWER CABLE America 1 Table 9-6 Accessories and Kits (LOGIQ P3 BT10) Item Part Name Part Number Description Quantity 1101 USB Footswitch 5151236 3 Pedal Footswitch 1 1102 Digital B/W Printer Thermal Printer 5160406 B/W Printer 1 1103 Color USB Thermal Printer- (Option) 5310886 Option part 1 1104 USB thumb Drive- (Option) 5308966 Option part 1 1105 LOGIQ P3 Application Software with Base ImageDVD 5368259 LOGIQ P3 Application Software with Base ImageDVD (R2.x.x) 1 1106 LOGIQ P3 Pro Application Software with Base ImageDVD 5397504 LOGIQ P3 Pro Application Software with Base ImageDVD (R2.x.x) 1 1107 LOGIQ P3 B/W Application Software with Base ImageDVD 5397506 LOGIQ P3 B/W Application Software with Base Image (R2.x.x) 1 1108 USB Hard Disk (160GB) - (Option) 5313598 USB Hard Disk (160GB) - (Option) 1 Chapter 9 Renewal Parts 9-19 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Item Part Name Part Number Description Quantity 1109 DeskJet Printer- (Option) 5309104 Option part 1 1110 ECG Module 5321614 Option Part 1 1111 Power Cord India 5337332 Power Cord India 1 1112 Power Cord China 5248395 Power Cord China 1 1113 POWER CABLE Europe 5248396 POWER CABLE Europe 1 1114 POWER CABLE Japan 5248393 POWER CABLE Japan 1 1115 POWER CABLE America 5248394 POWER CABLE America 1 1116 HP 470 Bluetooth Printer (BT 500 Bluetooth Dongle) 5400149 HP Bluetooth Printer 1 1117 Power Cord Brazil 5390874 Power Cord Brazil 1 1118 Power Cord Israel 5398510 Power Cord Israel 1 1119 Power Cord for UK/HK 5182816 Power Cord for UK/HK 1 1120 Power Cord Italy 5182940 Power Cord Italy 1 1121 Power Cord Denmark 5182083 Power Cord Denmark 1 1122 Power Cord Switzerland 5182235 Power Cord Switzerland 1 9-20 Section 9-12 - Accessories and Kits GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 9-13Probe Table 9-9 Probes for LOGIQ P3 Item Part Name Part Number Description Quantity 1201 4C 5123455 Probe (Center Frequency: 3.2MHz) 1 1202 E8C 2294641 Probe (Center Frequency: 6.5MHz) 1 1203 8C 2348094 Probe (Center Frequency: 6.5MHz) 1 1204 5CS 5143934 Probe (Center Frequency: 5.6MHz) 1 1205 8L 5140738 Probe (Center Frequency: 6.2MHz) 1 1206 3S 2323337 Probe (Center Frequency: 2.0MHz) 1 1207 11L 5171885 Probe (Center Frequency: 7.5MHz) 1 1208 E8CS 47236865 Probe (Center Frequency: 6.5MHz) 1 1209 T739 2259246 Probe(Center Frequency: 6.4MHz) 1 Along with the above Probes, LOGIQ P3 BT10 include the following Probes: 1210 3.8CA 5334810 Probe (Center Frequency: 3.75MHz±10%) 1 1211 6S 47236867 Probe (Center Frequency: 6.0MHz) 1 1212 7.5LA 5334811 Probe (Center Frequency: 7.5MHz±10%) 1 Chapter 9 Renewal Parts 9-21 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 9-14 Logiq P3 FRU List With Part Numbers Table 10: FRU List Part Number 9-22 Part Name 5314411 Connector Board 3PP Asm 5314412 Connector Board 2PP Asm 5315025 (LOGIQ P3) MST Board Asm 5388844 (LOGIQ P3 BT10) MST Board Asm 5308994 System on module (SOM) 5315026 CWD Assy 5315027 Rx PWA Asm with bracket 2404903 Transmit Board 5315028 (LOGIQ P3) LV and Power distribution Board Assy 5370323 (LOGIQ P3 BT10) Power distribution Board Assembly 5370455 Power Supply Assembly BT10 5397797 Power Supply with screw 5397502 Power Entry Module with Stickers 5389807 Power Cord Clamp P3-BT10 5313708 (LOGIQ P3) Rear Panel ASSY -100V / 220V 5368251 (LOGIQ P3BT10) Rear Panel ASSY 5314404 Keyboard Asm complete 5315106 A/N KB complete 5315029 TB Asm complete 5315107 TGC Asm 5315111 EMI cover set 5315113 HDD Asm 5315114 Side Left cover 5315115 Side Right cover 5315116 Front Cover 5315117 Rear cover 5315118 (LOGIQ P3) Front Castor Wheel Assy 5315119 (LOGIQ P3 BT10) Back Castor Wheels Assy 5368246 (LOGIQ P3) Front Castor Wheel Assy Section 9-14 - Logiq P3 FRU List With Part Numbers GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Table 10: FRU List 5368247 (LOGIQ P3 BT10) Back Castor Wheels Assy 5315120 Handle Assy 5310093 LCD Arm cover 5396925 P3 LCD Monitor DC 5219747 Cable Guard Clamp 5196448 (LOGIQ P3) Transformer Assembly 5268853 (LOGIQ P3BT10) Transformer Assembly 5315121 Top Cover Assy 5312274 5312274 SATA DVD RW Drive 5315122 KBD rear Cover Assy 5315502 Knob Set 5388845 (LOGIQ P3 BT10) Power Cable set 5388847 (LOGIQ P3 BT10) Signal Cable set 5315124 Key Caps 5308912-1 (LOGIQ P3) LOGIQ P3 Application Software with Base Image 5368259 (LOGIQ P3 BT10) LOGIQ P3 Application Software with Base Image 5337332 (LOGIQ P3) Power Cord India 2365882 (LOGIQ P3 BT10) Power Cord India 5248395 (LOGIQ P3 BT10) Power Cord China 5182816 (LOGIQ P3 BT10) Power Cord UK/HK 5182940 (LOGIQ P3 BT10) Power Cord Italy 5182083 (LOGIQ P3 BT10) Power Cord Denmark 5182235 (LOGIQ P3 BT10) Power Cord Switzerland 5398510 (LOGIQ P3 BT10) Power Cord Israel 5390874 (LOGIQ P3 BT10) Power Cord Brazil 5248396 POWER CABLE Europe 5248393 POWER CABLE Japan 5248394 POWER CABLE America 5151236 Foot-switch- (Option) 5262765 (LOGIQ P3) ECG Module- (Option) 5321614 (LOGIQ P3 BT10) ECG Module- (Option) 5160406 B/W USB Thermal Printer 5309104 DeskJet Printer- (Option) 5310886 Color USB Thermal Printer- (Option) Chapter 9 Renewal Parts 9-23 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Table 10: FRU List 9-24 5400149 HP Bluetooth Printer (BT 500 - Bluetooth Dongle) 5312274 SATA DVD Writer 5313598 USB Hard Disk- - (Option) 5313573 Probe Holder 5308996 1GB_USB_Thumb_Drive 5262796 Encoder set for Logiq A3 KBD 5315328-1 (LOGIQ P3) LOGIQ P3 Application Software For BW 5397506 (LOGIQ P3 BT10) LOGIQ P3 Application Software For BW 5315327-1 (LOGIQ P3) LOGIQ P3 Application Software For PRO 5397504 (LOGIQ P3) LOGIQ P3 Application Software For PRO 5334810 3.8CA Convex Array Probe 5334811 7.5LA Linear Array Probe 5314414 (LOGIQ P3 BT10) Fan Assy 5397507 (LOGIQ P3 BT10) Video Interface Board Section 9-14 - Logiq P3 FRU List With Part Numbers GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Chapter 10 Care & Maintenance Section 10-1 Overview 10-1-1 Periodic Maintenance Inspections It has been determined by engineering that your LOGIQ P3 system does not have any high wear components that fail with use, therefore no Periodic Maintenance Inspections are mandatory. Some Customers Quality Assurance Programs may require additional tasks and or inspections at a different frequency than listed in this manual. 10-1-2 Purpose of Chapter 10 This chapter describes Care & Maintenance on the scanner and peripherals. These procedures are intended to maintain the quality of the ultrasound systems performance. Read this chapter completely and familiarize yourself with the procedures before performing a task. Table 10-1 Contents in Chapter 10 Section Description Page Number 10-1 Overview 10-1 10-2 Why do Maintenance 10-2 10-3 Maintenance Task Schedule 10-2 10-4 Tools Required 10-4 10-5 System Maintenance 10-7 10-6 Using a Phantom 10-12 10-7 Electrical Safety Tests 10-12 10-8 When There's Too Much Leakage Current... 10-29 CAUTION Practice good ESD prevention. Wear an anti–static strap when handling electronic parts and even when disconnecting/connecting cables. DANGER BE SURE TO DISCONNECT THE SYSTEM POWER PLUG BEFORE YOU REMOVE ANY PARTS. BE CAUTIOUS WHENEVER POWER IS STILL ON AND COVERS ARE REMOVED. CAUTION Do not pull out or insert circuit boards while power is ON. CAUTION Do not operate this unit unless all board covers and frame panels are securely in place. System performance and cooling require this. Chapter 10 Care & Maintenance 10-1 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 10-2 Why do Maintenance 10-2-1 Keeping Records It is good business practice that ultrasound facilities maintain records of periodic and corrective maintenance. The Ultrasound Periodic Maintenance Inspection Certificate provides the customer with documentation that the ultrasound scanner is maintained on a periodic basis. A copy of the Ultrasound Periodic Maintenance Inspection Certificate should be kept in the same room or near the scanner. 10-2-2 Quality Assurance In order to gain accreditation from organizations such as the American College of Radiology (USA), it is the customer’s responsibility to have a quality assurance program in place for each scanner. The program must be directed by a medical physicists, the supervising radiologist/physician or appropriate designee. Routine quality control testing must occur regularly. The same tests are performed during each period so that changes can be monitored over time and effective corrective action can be taken. Testing results, corrective action and the effects of corrective action must be documented and maintained on the site. Your GE service representative can help you with establishing, performing and maintaining records for a quality assurance program. Please contact us for coverage information and/or price for service. Section 10-3 Maintenance Task Schedule 10-3-1 How often should care & maintenance tasks be performed? The Care & Maintenance Task Schedule (provided on page 10-3) specifies how often your LOGIQ P3 should be serviced and outlines items requiring special attention. NOTE: It is the customer’s responsibility to ensure the LOGIQ P3 care & maintenance is performed as scheduled in order to retain its high level of safety, dependability and performance. Your GE Service Representative has an in-depth knowlegde of your LOGIQ P3 ultrasound scanning system and can best provide competent, efficient service. Please contact us for coverage information and/or price for service. The service procedures and recommended intervals shown in the Care & Maintenance Task Schedule assumes that you use your LOGIQ P3 for an average patient load (10-12 per day) and use it as a primary mobile unit which is transported between diagnostic facilities. NOTE: 10-2 If conditions exist which exceed typical usage and patient load, then it is recommended to increase the maintenance frequencies. Section 10-2 - Why do Maintenance GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Table 10-2 Customer Care Schedule Service at Indicated Time Daily Weekly Monthly Per Facilities QA Program •* Clean Probes Notes * or before each use • Clean Probe Holders Inspect AC Mains Cable • Inspect Cables and Connectors • Clean Console • Mobile Unit Check Weekly More frequently depending on your environment • Clean Air filter Clean LCD • Inspect Wheels,Casters,brakes, and Swivel locks • Mobile unit check Daily Console Leakage Current Checks See Note Twice Annually Peripheral Leakage Current Checks See Note Twice Annually Surface Probe Leakage Current Checks See Note Twice Annually See Note Quarterly Annually See Note Twice Annually Endocavity Probe Leakage Current Checks Measurement Accuracy Checks NOTE: May require specialized equipment to complete NOTE: PMs are not mandatory, the table above is for reference only. Chapter 10 Care & Maintenance 10-3 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 10-4 Tools Required 10-4-1 Standard GE Tool Kit The following is a description of the “Standard” GE tool kit in the USA. Not all tools are required for PMs. Table 10-3 Overview of GE-1 Tool Kit Contents Tool ID 10-4 Description Tool ID Description 9-45358 Pliers Retaining Ring 9-XL9971MM Xcelite-hex Blade 1.27mm 9-4078 Scribe 9-XL9972MM Xcelite-hex Blade 1.5mm 9-44572 Wrench Open End 3/8 - 7/16 9-XL9973MM Xcelite-hex Blade 2 mm 9-44579 Wrench Open End 1/2 - 9/16 9-XL9974MM Xcelite-hex Blade 2.5mm 9-44579 Wrench Open End 1/2 - 9/16 9-XL9975MM Xcelite-hex Blade 3mm 9-45385 Pliers, Arc Joint 7 inch 9-XL9976MM Xcelite-hex Blade 4mm 9-45378 Pliers, Slip Joint 9-XL9977MM Xcelite-hex Blade 5mm 9-4518 Pliers, Long Nose, Miniature 9-XL991CM Handle 9-4518 Pliers, Long Nose, Miniature C2356E Screw starter - Kedman Quick Wedge 9-44776 Ignition Wrench Set, 10 pc. BLBO Box - 18 Compartment 9-44601 Wrench, Adj., 4 inch DWL4283T Box - 5 Compartment 9-4151 Screwdriver, Blade, Stubby 9-41322 Pickup Tool, Claw type 9-41421 Screwdriver, Blade, Pocket clip 9-6757 6 pc Needle File Set 9-41594 Screwdriver, Blade 1/8 in. x 4 in. 9-9487 Utility Knife 9-41581 Screwdriver, Blade 3/16 in. x 4 in. 9-45341 Pliers Vice Grip 10 inch 9-39451 20' Steel Tape, locking Spring load 9-3001 Xacto Pen Knife 9-GH807 Ratchet, Offset, Slotted 9-HT62002 Solder Aid, Fork and Hook 68-412 Ratchet, Offset, Phillips 9-4099 Mirror, Round, Telescoping 9-GH130 Tapered Reamer 9-GH3001 Steel Rule Decimal 6 inch 9-41584 Screwdriver, slotted 1/4 in.X 6 in. 9-GH300ME Steel Rule Metric 6 inch 9-4118 Screwdriver, Phillips #2, Stubby 9-XL9920 Xcelite-hex Blade.050 inch 9-41293 Screwdriver, Phillips #0 9-XL9921 Xcelite-hex Blade 1/16 inch 9-41294 Screwdriver, Phillips #1 9-XL9922 Xcelite-hex Blade 5/16 inch 9-41295 Screwdriver, Phillips #2 9-XL9923 Xcelite-hex Blade 3/32 inch 9-46677 Hex Keys, 20 pc., Metric 9-XL9924 Xcelite-hex Blade 1/8 inch 9-34701 1/4 in. Standard.Socket set (19 pc) 9-XL9925 Xcelite-hex Blade 5/32 inch 9-43499 1/2 inch Socket 1/4 inch drive 9-XL9926 Xcelite-hex Blade 3/16 inch 9-4355 Flex Spinner 9-XL99764 Xcelite-hex Blade 7/64 9-43523 Breaker 9-XL99964 Xcelite-hex Blade 9/64 9-43531 6 inch Ext. 9-XLM60 Mini-screwdriver kit Section 10-4 - Tools Required GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 Table 10-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Overview of GE-1 Tool Kit Contents (Continued) Tool ID Description Tool ID Description 9-65283 Case 8.5 in. x 4.5 in. x 2 in. Deep 9-45072 Pliers 6 inch Diagonal 9-46696 Hex Keys 9-XL100X Wire Stripper/Cutter 5 inch - 100X 9-39829 Torpedo Level, Magnetic 9-XL87CG Pliers - very fine needle nose-87CG 9-38461 Hammer, Ball Peen, 4 oz 9-WEWDT-07 Weller-Soldering-Replacement Tip(1) 9-4280 Universal Joint 1/4 inch 9-WS175-E Wiss - Surgical Scissors 9-WEW60P3 Weller - Soldering Iron, 3 wire KH174 Hemostat 5 inch Straight 9-WECT5B6 Weller - Soldering Iron Tip KH175 Hemostat 5 inch curved 9-WEWDP12 Weller - Desoldering Pump 9-Z9480121 Alignment tool (red) 93383 Flashlight Mini-Mag Lite (AAA Bat.) 9-GH408 Tweezers 21576 Brush - Bristle 9-4516 Pliers 4 1/4 inch Diagonal Table 10-4 Overview of GE-2 Tool Kit Contents GE-2 Sears Kit (#99034) Tool ID Description Tool ID Description 9-45381 Pliers, Arc Joint 9 1/2 inch 9-44067 Socket 1 1/16 in. for 1/2 in. drive 9-45092 Pliers, Linesman 8 1/2 inch 9-42679 Socket 10MM Hex for 1/2 in. drive (2273333) 9-42882 Punch, Pin 3/32 inch 9-44262 Extension 10 inch for 1/2 in. drive (2273405) 9-42884 Punch, Pin 5/32 inch 9-4258 3/8 inch to 1/2 inch Adapter 9-42886 Punch, Pin 1/4 inch 9-34374 3/8 inch Metric Socket Set - 12 PT 9-42973 Cold Chisel 1/2 inch 9-44311 16mm Socket 12 pt. 9-GH77 Center Punch Automatic 9-33485 Metal Socket Tray 9-GH890 File Handle, Adj. 9-33484 Metal Socket Tray 9-31276 File, Round, Bastard 8 inch 9-33484 Metal Socket Tray 9-31277 File, Half Round, Bastard 8 inch 9-52068 Tap and Drill Set 9-31263 File, Flat Mill 8 inch 9-52722 #6 Tap 21045C Close Quarter Saw 9-52723 #8 Tap 9-44604 Wrench, Adj 10 inch High Speed Drill Set 9-41587 Screwdriver 5/16 inch x 8 inch #36 Drill 9-41586 Screwdriver, Stubby 5/16 inch #29 Drill 9-GH19512 Countersink 1/2 inch 9-44741 12 PC Combination Wrench Set 9-44046 Chapter 10 Care & Maintenance 3/8 inch Socket Set 10-5 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 10-4-2 10-4-2-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Special Tools, Supplies and Equipment Specific Requirements for Care & Maintenance Table 10-5 Overview of Requirements for Care & Maintenance Tool Part Number Comments Electric Safety Analyzer DALE 600 46-285652G1 For 120V Unit Electric Safety Analyzer DALE 600E 46-328406G2 For 220V Units Leakage Current Ultrasound Kit 2113015 For 120V and 220V Units 46–194427P231 46–194427P279 Kit includes anti–static mat, wrist strap and cables for 200 to 240 V system 46–194427P369 3M #2204 Large adjustable wrist strap 46–194427P373 3M #2214 Small adjustable wrist strap 46–194427P370 3M #3051 conductive ground cord 46–194427P278 120V 46–194427P279 230V Digital Volt Meter (DVM) Anti Static Kit Anti Static Vacuum Cleaner Safety Analyzer 46–285652G1 QIQ Phantom E8370RB DALE 600 KIT (or equivalent) for electrical tests RMI Grayscale Target Model 403GS B/W Printer Cleaning Sheet See printer user manual for requirements Color Printer Cleaning Sheet See printer user manual for requirements Disposable Gloves Emergency Repair Disk 10-6 5173797 Emergency Repair Disk should be an external USB disk which compliance with local regulatory requirements. The HDD capacity should be over 30GB and should only have one hard disk partition. Refer to section 4-3-14-5 for how to use the emergency repair disk on LOGIQ P3. Section 10-4 - Tools Required GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 10-5 System Maintenance 10-5-1 Preliminary Checks The preliminary checks take about 15 minutes to perform. Refer to the system user documentation whenever necessary. NOTE: Recommended to have one Preventive Maintenance per year. Table 10-6 System Checks Step Item Description 1 Ask & Listen 2 Paperwork 3 Power up 4 Probes 5 Displays Verify proper display on the LCD. 6 Presets Backup all customer presets on an DVD-RW. Ask the customer if they have any problems or questions about the equipment. Fill in the top of the Ultrasound Inspection Certificate (see page 10- 30). Note all probes and system options. With AC input. Turn the system power on and verify that all fans and peripherals turn on. Watch the displays during power up to verify that no warning or error messages are displayed. Verify that the system properly recognizes all probes. Chapter 10 Care & Maintenance 10-7 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 10-5-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Functional Checks (See Also Chapter 4) The functional checks take about 60 minutes to perform. Refer to the system user documentation whenever necessary. 10-5-2-1 System Checks Table 10-7 ÷ System Functional Checks Step B-Mode Description Verify basic B-Mode (2D) operation. Check the basic system controls that affect this mode of operation. CF-Mode Verify basic CF-Mode (Color Flow Mode) operation. Check the basic system controls that affect this mode of operation. Doppler Modes Verify basic Doppler operation (PW if available). Check the basic system controls that affect this mode of operation. M-Mode Verify basic M-Mode operation. Check the basic system controls that affect this mode of operation. *Applicable Verify the basic operation of all optional modes such as Multi-Image, 3D, Harmonics, Cine,... etc. Software Options Check the basic system controls that affect each options operation. TXmit/Recv Elements Use the Visual Channel Utility on the loop connect to verify that all system Txmit/recv channels are functional. System Diagnostics Perform the Automatic Test, to verify that all boards function according to specification. Keyboard Test LCD NOTE: 10-8 Perform the Keyboard Test Procedure to verify that all keyboard controls are OK. Verify basic LCD display functions. Refer to Chapter 3 of the User Manual. Software Menu check Verify Software Menu display functions. Refer to Chapter 3 of the User Manual. Measurements Scan a gray scale phantom and use the measurement controls to verify distance and area calculation accuracy. Refer to the User Manual, Chapter 18, for measurement accuracy specifications. * Some software may be considered standard depending upon system model configuration. Section 10-5 - System Maintenance GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 10-5-2-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Peripheral/Option Checks If any peripherals or options are not part of the system configuration, the check can be omitted. Refer to the User Manual for a list of approved peripherals/options. Table 10-8 Step 10-5-3 10-5-3-1 Item B/W Printer Verify hardcopy output of the B/W video page printer. Clean heads and covers if necessary. 2 Color Printer Verify hardcopy output of the Color video page printer. Clean heads and covers if necessary. 3 DICOM 4 Footswitch 5 ECG Verify basic operation with customer. 6 DVD Verify that the DVD is functioning properly. Clean heads and covers if necessary. Verify that DICOM is functioning properly. Send an image to a DICOM device. Verify that the footswitch is functioning as programed. Clean as necessary. Input Power AC Power Inspection Step 1 10-5-4-1 Description 1 Table 10-9 10-5-4 GE Approved Peripheral/Hardware Option Functional Checks AC Inspection Item Description Unplug Cord Disconnect the mains cable from the wall and system. 2 Inspect 3 Verify Inspect it and its connectors for damage of any kinds. Verify that the LINE wires are properly attached to the terminals, and that no strands may cause a short circuit. Cleaning General Cleaning Table 10-10 General Cleaning Step Item 1 Console 2 3 Description Use a fluid detergent in warm water on a soft, damp cloth to carefully wipe the entire system. Be careful not to get the cloth too wet so that moisture does not enter the console. Probe Holder Clean probe holders. (they may need to be soaked to remove excess gel). LCD Use a soft, non-abrasive folder cloth. Gently wipe the LCD face. DO NOT use a glass cleaner that has a hydrocarbon base (such as Benzene, Methy Alcohol or Methy Ethyl Ketone) on LCD with the filter (antiglare shield). Chapter 10 Care & Maintenance 10-9 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 10-5-5 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Physical Inspection Table 10-11 Physical Checks Step Item 1 Labeling 2 10-10 Description Verify that all system labeling is present and in readable condition. Refer to User Manual, ...... for details. Scratches & Dents Inspect the console for dents, scratches or cracks. 3 Control Panel 4 Cables & Connectors Check all internal cable harnesses and connectors for wear and secure connector seating. Pay special attention to footswitch assembly and probe strain or bend reliefs. 5 Shielding & Covers Check to ensure that all EMI shielding, internal covers, air flow panels and screws are in place. Missing covers and hardware could cause EMI/RFI problems while scanning. 6 External I/O Check all connectors for damage. 7 Op Panel Lights Inspect keyboard and control panel. Note any damaged or missing items. Check for proper operation of all operator panel and Freeze Key light. Section 10-5 - System Maintenance GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 10-5-6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Optional Diagnostic Checks Optionally you can access the diagnostic software as described in Chapter 5 or 7. View the error logs and run desired diagnostics. 10-5-6-1 View the Logs 1.) Review the system error log for any problems. 2.) Check the temperature log to see if there are any trends that could cause problems in the future. 3.) Check the Configuration Log; update if needed. 10-5-7 10-5-7-1 Probe Maintenance Probe Related Checks Table 10-12 Probe Related Checks 10-5-7-2 Step Item 1 Probe Holder 2 Probes Description Clean probe holders (they may need to be soaked to remove excess gel). Thoroughly check the system probe connectors and remove dust from inside the connector sockets if necessary. Visually check for bent, damaged or missing pins Basic Probe Care The system user manuals and various probe handling cards provide a complete description of probe care, maintenance, cleaning and disinfection. Ensure that you are completely familiar with the proper care of GE probes. Ultrasound probes can be easily damaged by improper handling. See the User Manual and probe care cards for more details. Failure to follow these precautions can result in serious injury and equipment damage. Failure to properly handle or maintain a probe may also void its warranty. Any evidence of wear indicates the probe cannot be used. Do a visual check of the probe pins and system sockets before plugging in a probe. 10-5-7-3 Basic Probe Cleaning Refer to the User’s Manual for details on probe cleaning. NOTE: To help protect yourself from blood borne diseases, wear approved disposable gloves. These are made of nitrile derived from vegetable starch to prevent allergic latex reactions. NOTE: Failure to follow the prescribed cleaning or disinfection procedures will void the probe’s warranty. DO NOT soak or wipe the lens with any product not listed in the User Manual. Doing so could result in irreparable damage to the probe. Follow care instructions that came with the probe. NOTE: Disinfect a defective probe before you return it. Be sure to tag the probe as being disinfected. Chapter 10 Care & Maintenance 10-11 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 10-6 Using a Phantom See the Basic User Manual “Customer Maintenance” for information on using a phantom and quality assurance tests. Section 10-7 Electrical Safety Tests 10-7-1 Safety Test Overview The electrical safety tests in this section are based on and conform to IEC 60601-1 Medical Equipment Safety Standards. They are intended for the electrical safety evaluation of cord-connected, electrically operated, patient care equipment. If additional information is needed, refer to the IEC 60601-1 documents. WARNING THE USER MUST ENSURE THAT THE SAFETY INSPECTIONS ARE PERFORMED AT LEAST EVERY 6 MONTHS ACCORDING TO THE REQUIREMENTS OF THE PATIENT SAFETY STANDARD IEC-EN 60601-1. ONLY TRAINED PERSONS ARE ALLOWED TO PERFORM THE SAFETY INSPECTIONS MENTIONED ABOVE. CAUTION To avoid electrical shock, the unit under test must not be connected to other electrical equipment. The unit under test must not be contacted by users or patients while performing these tests. CAUTION Possible risk of infection. Do not handle soiled or contaminated probes and other components that have been in patient contact. Follow appropriate cleaning and disinfecting procedures before handling the equipment. Test the system, peripherals and probes for leakage current. Excessive leakage current can cause injury or death in sensitive patients. High leakage current can also indicate degradation of insulation and a potential for electrical failure. Do not use probes or equipment having excessive leakage current. To minimize the risk that a probe may shock someone the customer should: 10-12 • Not use a probe that is cracked or damaged in any way • Check probe leakage current: * once a year on surface probes * twice a year on endocavitary probes * whenever probe damage is suspected Section 10-6 - Using a Phantom GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 10-7-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL GEMS Leakage Current Limits The following limits are summarized for NFPA 99 (For USA), IEC 60601-1 Medical Equipment Safety Standards, and IEC 62353 Medical Electrical Equipment — Recurrent test and test after repair of medical electrical equipment. Measurement limits per IEC 60601-1 Medical Equipment Safety Standards, Table IV. Table 10-13 Chassis Leakage Current Limits—Accessible Metal Surfaces Normal Condition Open Ground Open Neutral 0.1 mA 0.5 mA 0.5 mA Table 10-14 Type BF Applied Part Leakage Current Limits - Non-Conductive (Floating) Surface and Cavity Probes All Countries Normal Condition Open Ground Open Neutral AC 0.1 mA 0.5 mA 0.5 mA DC** 0.01 mA 0.05 mA 0.05 mA Table 10-15 Type CF Applied Part Leakage Current Limits - Surgical Probes and ECG Connections Normal Condition Open Ground Open Neutral 0.01 mA 0.05 mA 0.05 mA * NOTE: *Measurement limits per IEC 60601-1 Medical Equipment Safety Standards, Table IV **Most meters (like Dale 600/601) measure a composite of the AC and DC leakage current. Chapter 10 Care & Maintenance 10-13 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 10-7-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Outlet Test - Wiring Arrangement Test all outlets in the area for proper grounding and wiring arrangement by plugging in the neon outlet tester and noting the combination of lights that are illuminated. Any problems found should be reported to the hospital immediately and the receptacle should not be used. Figure 10-1 Typical Alternate Outlet Tester The Dale 600 has self-contained lamps designed for testing the outlet wiring arrangement. Plug the Dale 600 into each outlet to be tested comparing the lamp status. Figure 10-2 Dale 600 Outlet Test NOTE: 10-14 No outlet tester can detect the condition where the Neutral (grounded supply) conductor and the Grounding (protective earth) conductor are reversed. If later tests indicate high leakage currents, this should be suspected as a possible cause and the outlet wiring should be visually inspected. Section 10-7 - Electrical Safety Tests GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 10-7-4 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Grounding Continuity CAUTION Electric Shock Hazard. The patient must not be contacted to the equipment during this test Measure the resistance from the third pin of the attachment plug to the exposed metal parts of the case. The ground wire resistance should be less than 0.2 ohms. Reference the procedure in the IEC 601-1.1. Figure 10-3 Ground Continuity Test 10-7-4-1 Meter Procedure Follow these steps to test the ground wire resistance. 1.) Turn the LOGIQ P3 unit OFF. 2.) Plug the unit into the meter, and the meter into the tested AC wall outlet. 3.) Plug the black chassis cable into the meter's “CHASSIS” connector and attach the black chassis cable clamp to an exposed metal part of the LOGIQ P3 unit.Set the meter's “FUNCTION” switch to the RESISTANCE position. 4.) Set the meter's “POLARITY” switch to the OFF (center) position. 5.) Measure and record the ground wire resistance. Chapter 10 Care & Maintenance 10-15 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 10-7-4-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Dale 600 - Ground Continuity The Dale 600 measures line cord resistance from the third pin of the attachment plug to the meter’s Chassis Cable clamp. Test the grounding continuity of the system to all exposed metal parts in accordance with the IEC 601-1.1 procedure as above. Refer to the Dale 600 Instruction Manual for meter self tests and operation. Record measured resistance of the grounding continuity. The ground wire resistance should be less than 0.2 (Use any safety analyzer.) Figure 10-4 Dale 600 Ground Continuity Test 10-16 Section 10-7 - Electrical Safety Tests GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 10-7-5 10-7-5-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Chassis Leakage Current Test Definition This test measures the current that would flow in a grounded person who touched accessible metal parts of the bedside station if the ground wire should break. The test verifies the isolation of the power line from the chassis. The meter is connected from accessible metal parts of the case to ground. Measurements should be made with the unit On and Off, with the power line polarity Normal and Reversed. Record the highest reading. CAUTION Electric Shock Hazard. When the meter's ground switch is OPEN, don't touch the unit! CAUTION Equipment damage possibility. Never switch the Polarity and the status of Neutral when the unit is powered ON. Be sure to turn the unit power OFF before switching them using the POLARITY switch and/or the NEUTRAL switch. Otherwise, the unit may be damaged. 10-7-5-2 Generic Procedure The test verifies the isolation of the power line from the chassis. The testing meter is connected from accessible metal parts of the case to ground. Measurements should be made with the unit ON and OFF, with the power line polarity Normal and Reversed. Record the highest reading of current. Figure 10-5 Set Up for Chassis Source Leakage Current, IEC 601-1 Clause 19 - Continuos Leakage Currents and Patient, Auxiliary Currents When using the Microguard or a similar test instrument, its power plug may be inserted into the wall outlet and the equipment under test is plugged into the receptacle on the panel of the meter. This places the meter in the grounding conductor and the current flowing from the case to ground will be indicated in any of the current ranges. The maximum allowable limit for chassis source leakage is shown in Table 10-13. Chapter 10 Care & Maintenance 10-17 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 10-7-5-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Dale 600 Meter Procedure When measuring system chassis currents with the Dale 600, always use the CHASSIS selection of the external/chassis function switch. This requires the ground clip lead and changing the meters switches in accordance with the IEC 601-1.1. Refer to the Dale 600 Instruction Manual for meter self-test and operation. Record the highest leakage current measured. Follow these steps to test the unit for leakage current. 1.)Turn the LOGIQ P3 unit OFF. 2.)Plug the unit into the meter, and the meter into the tested AC wall outlet 3.)Plug the black chassis cable into the meter's “CHASSIS” connector and attach the black chassis cable clamp to an exposed metal part of the LOGIQ P3. 4.)Set the tester's “FUNCTION” switch to CHASSIS position. Figure 10-6 Ground and Chassis Leakage Current Test 5.)Follow the test conditions described for respective test points shown in Table 10-16. TEST CONDITION 1 Mounting screw for probe receptacle 2 Wheel support 3 Mounting screw for peripheral plugged into unit 4 Mounting screw for other peripheral powered by unit Table 10-16 Chassis Leakage Current Test Condition 6.) Keep a record of the results with other hard copies of PM data kept on site. 10-18 Section 10-7 - Electrical Safety Tests GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 10-7-5-4 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Data Sheet for enclosure Source Leakage Current The test passes when all readings measure less than the value shown in Table 10-13. Record all data on the PM Inspection Certificate. Table 10-17 Typical Data Sheet for enclosure Source Leakage Current Unit Power Tester Polarity Switch Tester Neutral or Ground Switch Test 1 Speaker Cover Test 2 Real Panel Metal Parts Optional Test 3 Optional Test 4 Enter Name of tested peripheral here: 10-7-6 10-7-6-1 ON NORM OPEN ON NORM CLOSED ON REV OPEN ON REV CLOSED OFF NORM OPEN OFF NORM CLOSED OFF REV OPEN OFF REV CLOSED Isolated Patient Lead (Source) Leakage–Lead to Ground Definition This test measures the current which would flow to ground from any of the isolated ECG leads. The meter simulates a patient who is connected to the monitoring equipment and is grounded by touching some other grounded surface. Measurements should be made with the ground open and closed, with power line polarity normal and reversed, and with the ultrasound console Off and On. For each combination the operating controls, such as the lead switch, should be operated to find the worst case condition.Generic Procedure CAUTION Equipment damage possibility. Never switch the Polarity when the unit is powered ON. Be sure to turn the unit power OFF before switching the polarity using the POLARITY switch. Otherwise, the unit may be damaged. Chapter 10 Care & Maintenance 10-19 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 10-7-6-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Generic Procedure Measurements should be made with the ground open and closed, with power line polarity normal and reversed, and with the unit Off and On. For each combination, the operating controls such as the lead switch should be operated to find the worst case condition. The connection is at service entrance or on the supply side of a separately derived system Appliance power switch (use both “off” and “on” positions) Patient lead selector switch (if any) (activated as required) Polarity reversing switch (use both positions) Patient connected leads Appliance H (Black) H POWER OUTLET N N (White) G Internal circuitry Between each patient lead and ground G (Green) Insulating surface Building ground Current meter Grounding contact switch (use in both “open” and “closed” positions) H = Hot N = Neutral (grounded) G = Grounding conductor Figure 10-7 Test Circuit for Measuring Non-Isolated Patient Leads 10-7-6-3 Dale 600 Meter Procedure The Dale 600 provides five snap type ECG buttons for testing patient leads. Snap on all patient leads to the meter and assure that the ground clip is connected to the system’s ground terminal. Select the meter’s LEAD-GND function. Select and test each ECG lead positions (except “ALL”) of the LEAD selector, testing each to the power condition combinations found in “PATIENT LEAD LEAKAGE” table in the “PM CHECKLIST”. Record the highest leakage current measured for each Power selection. CAUTION Line voltage is applied to the ECG leads during this test. To avoid possible electric shock hazard, the system being tested must not be touched by patients, users or anyone while the ISO TEST switch is depressed. When the meter's ground switch is OPEN, don't touch the unit! Follow these steps to test the ECG module for leakage current. 1.) Turn the LOGIQ P3 unit OFF. 2.) Plug the unit into the meter, and the meter into the tested AC wall outlet. 3.) Plug the black chassis cable into the meter's “CHASSIS” connector and attach the black chassis cable clamp to an exposed metal part of the LOGIQ P3 unit. 4.) Connect the patient leads to the corresponding snaps located at the upper front of the Dale 600/ 600E. Lead nomenclature for this test is not important. 10-20 Section 10-7 - Electrical Safety Tests GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 10-7-6-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Dale 600 Meter Procedure (cont’d) Figure 10-8 ECG Leakage Current Test 5.) Set the meter's “FUNCTION” switch to LEAD TO GROUND position to measure the patient lead to ground leakage current. 6.) Select and test each ECG lead positions (except ALL) of the LEAD selector, testing each to the power condition combinations. Table 10-18 Testing Power Conditions ECG Power Meter’s Polarity Switch Meter’s Neutral Switch ON NORM CLOSED ON NORM OPEN ON REVERSE CLOSED ON REVERSE OPEN OFF NORM CLOSED OFF NORM OPEN OFF REVERSE CLOSED OFF REVERSE OPEN Chapter 10 Care & Maintenance 10-21 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 10-7-6-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Dale 600 Meter Procedure (cont’d) 7.) Record the patient lead to ground leakage current measured on the data sheet. 8.) Set the meter's “FUNCTION” switch to LEAD TO LEAD position to measure the lead to lead leakage current. 9.) Select and test each ECG lead positions (except ALL) of the LEAD selector, testing each to the power condition combinations. 10.)Record the lead to lead leakage current measured on the data sheet. 11.)Set the meter's “FUNCTION” switch to LEAD ISO position to measure the patient lead isolation current. 12.)Select and test each ECG lead positions (except ALL) of the LEAD selector, testing each to the power condition combinations. 13.)Depress the rocker switch to ISO TEST and read the isolation current. To apply the voltage to the lead safely, the voltage is only applied when the rocker switch is depressed to ISO TEST. 14.)Record the patient lead isolation current measured on the data sheet. 10-7-7 Isolated Patient Lead (Source) Leakage–Lead to Lead Reference the procedure in the IEC 60601-1. When using the Dale 600, switch the meter’s function selector to the LEAD-LEAD position. Select and test each of the five ECG lead positions (except ALL) on the LEAD selector, testing each to the power condition combinations found in the table. Record the highest leakage current measured. 10-7-7-1 Dale 600 Patient Lead Tests NEUTRAL POLARITY 1.) Closed Normal 2.) Open Normal 3.) Closed Reversed 4.) Open Reversed 10-7-8 Isolated Patient Lead (Sink) Leakage-Isolation Test Reference the procedure in the IEC 60601-1. When using the Dale 600, switch the meter’s function selector to the LEAD-ISO. Select the ALL position on the lead selector. Depress the rocker switch to ISO TEST to test lead isolation. CAUTION Line voltage is applied to the ECG leads during this test. To avoid possible electric shock hazard, the system being tested must not be touched by patients, users or anyone while the ISO TEST switch is depressed. NOTE: 10-22 It is not necessary to test each lead individually or power condition combinations as required in previous tests. Section 10-7 - Electrical Safety Tests GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 10-7-8-1 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Data Sheet for ECG Leakage Current The test passes when all readings measure less than the value shown in the table below. Record all data on the PM Inspection Certificate. Table 10-19 Maximum Allowance Limit for ECG Leakage Current Maximum Allowance Limit Patient Lead to Ground Leakage Current Test AC Power Source GROUND OPEN GROUND CLOSED 115V 10uA 10uA 230V 500uA 10uA and Patient Lead to Lead Leakage Current Test Table 10-20 Maximum Allowance Limit for ECG Leakage Current AC Power Source Maximum Allowance Limit 115V 20uA 230V 5mA Patient Lead Isolation Current Test Table 10-21 Typical Data Sheet for ECG Leakage Current ECG Power Tester Polarity Switch Tester Ground Switch ON NORM CLOSED ON REVERSE CLOSED ON NORM OPEN ON REVERSE OPEN OFF NORM CLOSED OFF REVERSE CLOSED OFF NORM OPEN OFF REVERSE OPEN Tester Lead Selector RL RA Chapter 10 Care & Maintenance LA LL C 10-23 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 10-7-9 10-7-9-1 NOTE: 10-7-9-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Probe Leakage Current Test Definition This test measures the current that would flow to ground from any of the probes through a patient who is being scanned and becomes grounded by touching some other grounded surface.Some leakage current is expected on each probe, depending on its design. Small variations in probe leakage currents are normal from probe to probe. Other variations will result from differences in line voltage and test lead placement. It is abnormal if no leakage current is measured. If no leakage current is detected, check the configuration of the test equipment. Test Equipment Table 10-22 Test Equipment kits (Chapter 10 LOGIQ P3 Service Manual) 10-24 Kit Description Contents 46-285652G1 Dale 601 ULTRASOUND SAFETY ANALYZER FIELD KIT for 120V unit • • • • • • • ELECTRICAL SAFETY ANALYZER, DALE, MODEL 601 for 120V unit Vendor MODEL 600/100 8FT CHASSIS GROUND CABLE Vendor MODEL 600/102 6FT SALINE BATH GROUND CABLE Vendor MODEL 600/202 ULTRASOUND PROBE ADAPTER Vendor MODEL 600/600 SOFT CARRYING CASE Vendor MODEL 600/900 OPERATORS MANUAL Vendor MODEL 600/901 LMINATED OPERATORS GUIDE 46-328406G2 Dale 601E ULTRASOUND SAFETY ANALYZER FIELD KIT for 220V unit • • • • • • • • ELECTRICAL SAFETY ANALYZER, DALE, MODEL 601E for 220V unit Vendor MODEL 600/100 8FT CHASSIS GROUND CABLE Vendor MODEL 600/101 16FT CHASSIS GROUND CABLE Vendor MODEL 600/103 8FT CHASSIS GROUND PROBE Vendor MODEL 600/200 8FT EXTERNAL LEAKAGE GROUND CABLE #20 WIRE W/MINIGATOR CLIPS, 2 Ft CARRYING CASE and foam padding Vendor MODEL 600/900 OPERATORS MANUAL Section 10-7 - Electrical Safety Tests GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 10-7-9-2 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Test Equipment (cont’d) . Table 10-23 Test Equipment and Accessory Description Dale Part number Vendor MODEL 600/100 46-285647P2 Accessory Name Picture Description Used on DALE601/601E to measure earth resistance and enclosure leakage current. Also used as reference lead for external measurement. CHASSIS CABLE Black coil with extended length and black grips Vendor MODEL 600/102 46-285647P4 Also referred to as “Saline Probe” or “Saline Bath Ground Cable”. Measures earth resistance and enclosure leakage current. Also used for grounding saline baths for isolation testing of probes. CHASSIS GROUND PROBE Black coil cord with needle probe for testing receptacles and for tight spaces. Used on DALE601/601E. This probe may be substituted for the 600/100 Chassis Cable, and used as a probe instead of a clamp. Standard auxiliary cable for external measurements of leakage current and voltage gradient between two surfaces. Vendor MODEL 600/200 Used on DALE601/601E to measure: ISO/EXTERNAL LEAKAGE CABLE • Point-to-Point Leakage Current • Probe and Transducer Isolation Current 46-285647P6 Black coiled cord with red grips. Chapter 10 Care & Maintenance May only be connected to the female connector of the Analyzer, labeled EXTERNAL 10-25 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 10-7-9-3 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Generic Procedure for Leakage current Measurements should be made with the ground open and closed, with power line polarity normal and reversed, and with the unit Off and On. For each combination, the probe must be active to find the worst case condition. Saline Figure 10-9 Set Up for Probe Leakage Current NOTE: 10-7-9-4 Each probe will have some amount of leakage current, dependent on its design. Small variations in probe leakage currents are normal from probe to probe. Other variations will result from differences in line voltage and test lead placement. Meter Procedure Using Dale Meter to Measure Leakage Current The ultrasound probe’s imaging area is immersed in a solution along with a grounding probe from the test meter to complete the current path. The solution is a mixture of water and salt. The salt adds free ions to the water, making it conductive. Use mixture of 1 Litre of H2O (water) with 9 grams of table salt, mixed thoroughly. Follow these steps to test each probe for leakage current: 1.) Turn OFF the LOGIQ P3 unit. 2.) Plug the unit’s mains power cord into the test meter, and plug the test meter into the tested AC wall outlet. 3.) Plug the Chassis Ground Probe (saline probe) into the test meter's “CHASSIS” connector. 4.) Set the test meter's “FUNCTION” switch to “CHASSIS” (Dale 600) or "ENCLOSURE LEAKAGE" (Dale 601). 5.) Connect the probe to be tested to the LOGIQ P3 unit. 6.) Put the saline probe and the probe’s probe face (imaging area of the probe) into the saline bath.. CAUTION To avoid probe damage and possible electric shock, do not immerse probes into any liquid beyond the level indicated in the probe users manual. Do not touch the probe, conductive liquid or any part of the unit under test while the ISO TEST switch is depressed. 7.) Power ON the LOGIQ P3 unit. 8.) After the LOGIQ P3 unit has completed the boot process, select the probe to be tested so it is the active probe. 9.) Depress the LIFT GROUND rocker switch and record the highest current reading. 10.)Follow the test conditions described for every probe. The test passes when all readings measure less than the values shown in Table 10-14 and Table 10-15. 10-26 Section 10-7 - Electrical Safety Tests GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 10-7-9-5 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Meter Procedure Using Probe Adaptor Figure 10-10 Transducer Source Leakage Current Test 11.)Set the meter's “FUNCTION” switch to EXTERNAL position. 12.)Add the saline probe and the imaging area of the probe into the saline bath. 13.)Have unit power ON for the first part; turn it OFF for the second half. 14.)Depress the ISO TEST rocker switch and record the highest current reading. 15.)Follow the test conditions described in Table 10-24 for every transducer. 16.)Keep a record of the results with other hand copies of PM data. Chapter 10 Care & Maintenance 10-27 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 10-7-9-6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Data Sheet for Transducer Source Leakage Current The test passes when all readings measure less than the values shown in Table 10-13. Record all data on the PM Inspection Certificate. CAUTION Equipment damage possibility. Never switch the Polarity and the status of Neutral when the unit is powered ON. Be sure to turn the unit power OFF before switching them using the POLARITY switch and/or the NEUTRAL switch. Otherwise, the unit may be damaged . Table 10-24 Typical Data Sheet For Transducer Source Leakage Current Transducer Tested: 10-28 Unit Power Tester Power Polarity Switch Tester GROUND or NUETRAL Switch ON NORM OPEN ON NORM CLOSED ON REV OPEN ON REV CLOSED OFF NORM OPEN OFF NORM CLOSED OFF REV OPEN OFF REV CLOSED Section 10-7 - Electrical Safety Tests Measurement GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 10-8 When There's Too Much Leakage Current... AC/DC FAILS Check any broken of the AC/DC adapter and its cable. Replace a new one if any portion defective. ENCLOSURE FAILS Check any broken of the enclosure. Replace any defective part. Inspect wiring for bad crimps, poor connections, or damage. Test the wall outlet; verify it is grounded and is free of other wiring abnormalities. Notify the user or owner to correct any deviations. As a work around, check the other outlets to see if they could be used instead. NOTE: No outlet tester can detect the condition where the white neutral wire and the green grounding wire are reversed. If later tests indicate high leakage currents, this should be suspected as a possible cause and the outlet wiring should be visually inspected. PROBE FAILS Change another probe to confirm if the fail is caused by console. NOTE: Each probe will have some amount of leakage, dependent on its design. Small variations in probe leakage currents are normal from probe to probe. Other variations will result from differences in line voltage and test lead placement. The maximum allowable leakage current for body surface contact probe differs from inter-cavity probe. Be sure to enter the correct probe type in the appropriate space on the check list. If excessive leakage current is slot dependent, inspect the system connector for bent pins, poor connections, and ground continuity. If the problem remains with the probe, replace the probe. PERIPHERAL FAILS Inspect wiring for bad crimps, poor connections, or damage. STILL FAILS If all else fails, begin isolation by removing the probes, external peripherals, then the on board ones, one at a time while monitoring the leakage current measurement. NEW UNIT If the leakage current measurement tests fail on a new unit and if situation can not be corrected, submit a Safety Failure Report to document the system problem. Remove unit from operation. Chapter 10 Care & Maintenance 10-29 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL ULTRASOUND INSPECTION CERTIFICATE Customer Name: System ID: Dispatch Number / Date Performed: Warranty/Contract/HBS System Type Model Number: Serial Number: Manufacture Date: Probe 1: Frequency: Scan Format*: Model Number: Serial Number: Probe 2: Frequency: Scan Format*: Model Number: Serial Number: Probe 3: Frequency: Scan Format*: Model Number: Serial Number: Probe 4: Frequency: Scan Format*: Model Number: Serial Number: Probe 5: Frequency: Scan Format*: Model Number: Serial Number: * Scan Format: Phased Array, Linear Array, Curved Array, Mechanical Array or Other FUNCTIONAL CHECKS Functional Check (if applicable) PHYSICAL INSPECTION AND CLEANING Physical Inspection and Cleaning (if applicable) OK? or N/A B-Mode Function Console Doppler Modes Function LCD CF-Mode Function External I/O M-Mode Function Cables and Connectors Applicable Software Options GE Approved Peripherals (DVD-RW, Printer) Applicable Hardware Options Labeling (see User Manual for Labeling) Inspect Clean Control Panel LCD Measurement Accuracy GE Approved Peripherals COMMENTS: ______________________________________________________________________________ ______________________________________________________________________________ ______________________________________________________________________________ ______________________________________________________________________________ 10-30 Section 10-8 - When There's Too Much Leakage Current... GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL ELECTRICAL SAFETY Electrical Test Performed Max Value Allowed Value Measured OK? Comments OK? Comments Outlet (correct ground &wiring config.) Type BF Applied Part Leakage Current Limits- Probe enclosure Source Leakage Current Chassis Leakage Current Limits Peripheral 1 Leakage Current Peripheral 2 Leakage Current PROBES Probe Number (from previous page) Max Value Allowed Max Value Measured Probe 1: Probe 2: Probe 3: Final Check. All system covers are in place. System scans with all probes as expected. Accepted by: ______________________________________________________________________ Chapter 10 Care & Maintenance 10-31 GE HEALTHCARE DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 10-32 PROPRIETARY TO GE LOGIQ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Section 10-8 - When There's Too Much Leakage Current... GE MEDICAL SYSTEMS DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 A Abbreviations 2 Archiving Images Move 30 B Backup Patient Database 27 Preset Configurations 27 Basic Measurements Functional Checks 24 Body pattern display location 9 Boot Up 10 C Caps lock display location 9 CE Compliance 19 Cine gauge display location 9 Color Mode Overview 20 Connectivity Worksheet 28 Contact Information 20 Control Panel 7 Conventions Conventions Used in Book 4 Customer Assistance 20 D Dangerous Procedure Warnings 18 Date/Time display location 9 Depth scale display location 9 DICOM Network Function 10 E Electrical requirements 3 Electrical Safety 11 Electrostatic Discharge Warning 19 EMI 19 ESD 19 Exam study display location 9 F Focal zone display location 9 LOGIQ™ P3 SERVICE MANUAL Functional Checks Basic Measurements 24 Control Panel 7 Image Management 26 Monitor Display 9 Peripherals 37 Probes/Connector Usage 25 G Gathering Trouble Data 2 General Cleaning 9 Gray/color bar display location 9 H Hazard Icons 5 Hospital name display location 9 Human Safety 10 I Image Management Functional Checks 26 Image preview display location 9 Imaging parameters display location 9 Inrush Current 3, 4 Institution name display location 9 M Manpower Requirements 6 Measurement summary window display location 9 Mechanical Safety 10 Media Formatting 27 Models Covered 2 Monitor Display Functioanl Checks 9 Monitor display location 9 Move Archiving Images 30 O Operator identification display location 9 P P4 Key Function 4, 6 Patient identification Index - 1 GE MEDICAL SYSTEMS DIRECTION 5308917-100, REVISION 6 LOGIQ™ P3 SERVICE MANUAL display location 9 Patient name display location 9 Peripherals Functional Checks 37 Power On 10 Power Requirements 3 electrical 3 stability 4 Power Stability Requirements 4 Probe Connector Cleaning 11 Probe identifier display location 9 Probe orientation marker display location 9 Probes/Connector Usage Functional Checks 25 R Required Features 8 Restore Patient Database 29 Preset Configurations 29 S Safety Considerations 10 Screen Captures 6 System Maintenance 7 System Manufacturer 21 T TGC display location 9 Touch Panel Functional Checks 7 Trouble Image with Logs 3 Troubleshooting Gathering Trouble Data 2 Screen Captures 6 Trouble Image with Logs 3 Vital System Information 2 W Warnings and Cautions 10 Index - 2 -